Update years in copyright notice; nfc.
[bpt/emacs.git] / src / xterm.c
1 /* X Communication module for terminals which understand the X protocol.
2 Copyright (C) 1989, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001,
3 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4
5 This file is part of GNU Emacs.
6
7 GNU Emacs is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
10 any later version.
11
12 GNU Emacs is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
16
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with GNU Emacs; see the file COPYING. If not, write to
19 the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
20 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA. */
21
22 /* New display code by Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>. */
23 /* Xt features made by Fred Pierresteguy. */
24
25 #include <config.h>
26
27 /* On 4.3 these lose if they come after xterm.h. */
28 /* Putting these at the beginning seems to be standard for other .c files. */
29 #include <signal.h>
30
31 #include <stdio.h>
32
33 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS
34
35 #include "lisp.h"
36 #include "blockinput.h"
37
38 /* Need syssignal.h for various externs and definitions that may be required
39 by some configurations for calls to signal later in this source file. */
40 #include "syssignal.h"
41
42 /* This may include sys/types.h, and that somehow loses
43 if this is not done before the other system files. */
44 #include "xterm.h"
45 #include <X11/cursorfont.h>
46
47 /* Load sys/types.h if not already loaded.
48 In some systems loading it twice is suicidal. */
49 #ifndef makedev
50 #include <sys/types.h>
51 #endif /* makedev */
52
53 #ifdef BSD_SYSTEM
54 #include <sys/ioctl.h>
55 #endif /* ! defined (BSD_SYSTEM) */
56
57 #include "systty.h"
58 #include "systime.h"
59
60 #ifndef INCLUDED_FCNTL
61 #include <fcntl.h>
62 #endif
63 #include <ctype.h>
64 #include <errno.h>
65 #include <setjmp.h>
66 #include <sys/stat.h>
67 /* Caused redefinition of DBL_DIG on Netbsd; seems not to be needed. */
68 /* #include <sys/param.h> */
69
70 #include "charset.h"
71 #include "coding.h"
72 #include "ccl.h"
73 #include "frame.h"
74 #include "dispextern.h"
75 #include "fontset.h"
76 #include "termhooks.h"
77 #include "termopts.h"
78 #include "termchar.h"
79 #include "gnu.h"
80 #include "disptab.h"
81 #include "buffer.h"
82 #include "window.h"
83 #include "keyboard.h"
84 #include "intervals.h"
85 #include "process.h"
86 #include "atimer.h"
87 #include "keymap.h"
88
89 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
90 #include <X11/Shell.h>
91 #endif
92
93 #ifdef HAVE_SYS_TIME_H
94 #include <sys/time.h>
95 #endif
96 #ifdef HAVE_UNISTD_H
97 #include <unistd.h>
98 #endif
99
100 #ifdef USE_GTK
101 #include "gtkutil.h"
102 #endif
103
104 #ifdef USE_LUCID
105 extern int xlwmenu_window_p P_ ((Widget w, Window window));
106 extern void xlwmenu_redisplay P_ ((Widget));
107 #endif
108
109 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
110
111 extern void free_frame_menubar P_ ((struct frame *));
112 extern struct frame *x_menubar_window_to_frame P_ ((struct x_display_info *,
113 int));
114 #endif
115
116 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
117 #if (XtSpecificationRelease >= 5) && !defined(NO_EDITRES)
118 #define HACK_EDITRES
119 extern void _XEditResCheckMessages ();
120 #endif /* not NO_EDITRES */
121
122 /* Include toolkit specific headers for the scroll bar widget. */
123
124 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
125 #if defined USE_MOTIF
126 #include <Xm/Xm.h> /* for LESSTIF_VERSION */
127 #include <Xm/ScrollBar.h>
128 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
129
130 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
131 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Simple.h>
132 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Scrollbar.h>
133 #include <X11/Xaw3d/ThreeD.h>
134 #else /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
135 #include <X11/Xaw/Simple.h>
136 #include <X11/Xaw/Scrollbar.h>
137 #endif /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
138 #ifndef XtNpickTop
139 #define XtNpickTop "pickTop"
140 #endif /* !XtNpickTop */
141 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
142 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
143
144 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
145
146 #if ! defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) && ! defined (USE_GTK)
147 #define x_any_window_to_frame x_window_to_frame
148 #define x_top_window_to_frame x_window_to_frame
149 #endif
150
151 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
152 #include "widget.h"
153 #ifndef XtNinitialState
154 #define XtNinitialState "initialState"
155 #endif
156 #endif
157
158 #define abs(x) ((x) < 0 ? -(x) : (x))
159
160 /* Default to using XIM if available. */
161 #ifdef USE_XIM
162 int use_xim = 1;
163 #else
164 int use_xim = 0; /* configure --without-xim */
165 #endif
166
167 \f
168
169 /* Non-nil means Emacs uses toolkit scroll bars. */
170
171 Lisp_Object Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars;
172
173 /* Non-zero means that a HELP_EVENT has been generated since Emacs
174 start. */
175
176 static int any_help_event_p;
177
178 /* Last window where we saw the mouse. Used by mouse-autoselect-window. */
179 static Lisp_Object last_window;
180
181 /* Non-zero means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties. */
182
183 int x_use_underline_position_properties;
184
185 /* This is a chain of structures for all the X displays currently in
186 use. */
187
188 struct x_display_info *x_display_list;
189
190 /* This is a list of cons cells, each of the form (NAME
191 . FONT-LIST-CACHE), one for each element of x_display_list and in
192 the same order. NAME is the name of the frame. FONT-LIST-CACHE
193 records previous values returned by x-list-fonts. */
194
195 Lisp_Object x_display_name_list;
196
197 /* Frame being updated by update_frame. This is declared in term.c.
198 This is set by update_begin and looked at by all the XT functions.
199 It is zero while not inside an update. In that case, the XT
200 functions assume that `selected_frame' is the frame to apply to. */
201
202 extern struct frame *updating_frame;
203
204 /* This is a frame waiting to be auto-raised, within XTread_socket. */
205
206 struct frame *pending_autoraise_frame;
207
208 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
209 /* The application context for Xt use. */
210 XtAppContext Xt_app_con;
211 static String Xt_default_resources[] = {0};
212 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
213
214 /* Non-zero means user is interacting with a toolkit scroll bar. */
215
216 static int toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction;
217
218 /* Non-zero means to not move point as a result of clicking on a
219 frame to focus it (when focus-follows-mouse is nil). */
220
221 int x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position;
222
223 /* Non-zero timeout value means ignore next mouse click if it arrives
224 before that timeout elapses (i.e. as part of the same sequence of
225 events resulting from clicking on a frame to select it). */
226
227 static unsigned long ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout;
228
229 /* Mouse movement.
230
231 Formerly, we used PointerMotionHintMask (in standard_event_mask)
232 so that we would have to call XQueryPointer after each MotionNotify
233 event to ask for another such event. However, this made mouse tracking
234 slow, and there was a bug that made it eventually stop.
235
236 Simply asking for MotionNotify all the time seems to work better.
237
238 In order to avoid asking for motion events and then throwing most
239 of them away or busy-polling the server for mouse positions, we ask
240 the server for pointer motion hints. This means that we get only
241 one event per group of mouse movements. "Groups" are delimited by
242 other kinds of events (focus changes and button clicks, for
243 example), or by XQueryPointer calls; when one of these happens, we
244 get another MotionNotify event the next time the mouse moves. This
245 is at least as efficient as getting motion events when mouse
246 tracking is on, and I suspect only negligibly worse when tracking
247 is off. */
248
249 /* Where the mouse was last time we reported a mouse event. */
250
251 static XRectangle last_mouse_glyph;
252 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_press_frame;
253
254 /* The scroll bar in which the last X motion event occurred.
255
256 If the last X motion event occurred in a scroll bar, we set this so
257 XTmouse_position can know whether to report a scroll bar motion or
258 an ordinary motion.
259
260 If the last X motion event didn't occur in a scroll bar, we set
261 this to Qnil, to tell XTmouse_position to return an ordinary motion
262 event. */
263
264 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_scroll_bar;
265
266 /* This is a hack. We would really prefer that XTmouse_position would
267 return the time associated with the position it returns, but there
268 doesn't seem to be any way to wrest the time-stamp from the server
269 along with the position query. So, we just keep track of the time
270 of the last movement we received, and return that in hopes that
271 it's somewhat accurate. */
272
273 static Time last_mouse_movement_time;
274
275 /* Incremented by XTread_socket whenever it really tries to read
276 events. */
277
278 #ifdef __STDC__
279 static int volatile input_signal_count;
280 #else
281 static int input_signal_count;
282 #endif
283
284 /* Used locally within XTread_socket. */
285
286 static int x_noop_count;
287
288 /* Initial values of argv and argc. */
289
290 extern char **initial_argv;
291 extern int initial_argc;
292
293 extern Lisp_Object Vcommand_line_args, Vsystem_name;
294
295 /* Tells if a window manager is present or not. */
296
297 extern Lisp_Object Vx_no_window_manager;
298
299 extern Lisp_Object Qeql;
300
301 extern int errno;
302
303 /* A mask of extra modifier bits to put into every keyboard char. */
304
305 extern EMACS_INT extra_keyboard_modifiers;
306
307 /* The keysyms to use for the various modifiers. */
308
309 Lisp_Object Vx_alt_keysym, Vx_hyper_keysym, Vx_meta_keysym, Vx_super_keysym;
310 Lisp_Object Vx_keysym_table;
311 static Lisp_Object Qalt, Qhyper, Qmeta, Qsuper, Qmodifier_value;
312
313 static Lisp_Object Qvendor_specific_keysyms;
314 static Lisp_Object Qlatin_1;
315
316 extern XrmDatabase x_load_resources P_ ((Display *, char *, char *, char *));
317 extern int x_bitmap_mask P_ ((FRAME_PTR, int));
318
319 static int x_alloc_nearest_color_1 P_ ((Display *, Colormap, XColor *));
320 static void x_set_window_size_1 P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int));
321 static const XColor *x_color_cells P_ ((Display *, int *));
322 static void x_update_window_end P_ ((struct window *, int, int));
323 void x_delete_display P_ ((struct x_display_info *));
324 static unsigned int x_x_to_emacs_modifiers P_ ((struct x_display_info *,
325 unsigned));
326 static int x_io_error_quitter P_ ((Display *));
327 int x_catch_errors P_ ((Display *));
328 void x_uncatch_errors P_ ((Display *, int));
329 void x_lower_frame P_ ((struct frame *));
330 void x_scroll_bar_clear P_ ((struct frame *));
331 int x_had_errors_p P_ ((Display *));
332 void x_wm_set_size_hint P_ ((struct frame *, long, int));
333 void x_raise_frame P_ ((struct frame *));
334 void x_set_window_size P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int));
335 void x_wm_set_window_state P_ ((struct frame *, int));
336 void x_wm_set_icon_pixmap P_ ((struct frame *, int));
337 void x_initialize P_ ((void));
338 static void x_font_min_bounds P_ ((XFontStruct *, int *, int *));
339 static int x_compute_min_glyph_bounds P_ ((struct frame *));
340 static void x_update_end P_ ((struct frame *));
341 static void XTframe_up_to_date P_ ((struct frame *));
342 static void XTset_terminal_modes P_ ((void));
343 static void XTreset_terminal_modes P_ ((void));
344 static void x_clear_frame P_ ((void));
345 static void frame_highlight P_ ((struct frame *));
346 static void frame_unhighlight P_ ((struct frame *));
347 static void x_new_focus_frame P_ ((struct x_display_info *, struct frame *));
348 static void x_focus_changed P_ ((int, int, struct x_display_info *,
349 struct frame *, struct input_event *));
350 static void x_detect_focus_change P_ ((struct x_display_info *,
351 XEvent *, struct input_event *));
352 static void XTframe_rehighlight P_ ((struct frame *));
353 static void x_frame_rehighlight P_ ((struct x_display_info *));
354 static void x_draw_hollow_cursor P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *));
355 static void x_draw_bar_cursor P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int,
356 enum text_cursor_kinds));
357
358 static void x_clip_to_row P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int, GC));
359 static void x_flush P_ ((struct frame *f));
360 static void x_update_begin P_ ((struct frame *));
361 static void x_update_window_begin P_ ((struct window *));
362 static void x_after_update_window_line P_ ((struct glyph_row *));
363 static struct scroll_bar *x_window_to_scroll_bar P_ ((Display *, Window));
364 static void x_scroll_bar_report_motion P_ ((struct frame **, Lisp_Object *,
365 enum scroll_bar_part *,
366 Lisp_Object *, Lisp_Object *,
367 unsigned long *));
368 static void x_check_fullscreen P_ ((struct frame *));
369 static void x_check_expected_move P_ ((struct frame *));
370 static int handle_one_xevent P_ ((struct x_display_info *, XEvent *,
371 int *, struct input_event *));
372
373
374 /* Flush display of frame F, or of all frames if F is null. */
375
376 static void
377 x_flush (f)
378 struct frame *f;
379 {
380 BLOCK_INPUT;
381 if (f == NULL)
382 {
383 Lisp_Object rest, frame;
384 FOR_EACH_FRAME (rest, frame)
385 x_flush (XFRAME (frame));
386 }
387 else if (FRAME_X_P (f))
388 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
389 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
390 }
391
392
393 /* Remove calls to XFlush by defining XFlush to an empty replacement.
394 Calls to XFlush should be unnecessary because the X output buffer
395 is flushed automatically as needed by calls to XPending,
396 XNextEvent, or XWindowEvent according to the XFlush man page.
397 XTread_socket calls XPending. Removing XFlush improves
398 performance. */
399
400 #define XFlush(DISPLAY) (void) 0
401
402 \f
403 /***********************************************************************
404 Debugging
405 ***********************************************************************/
406
407 #if 0
408
409 /* This is a function useful for recording debugging information about
410 the sequence of occurrences in this file. */
411
412 struct record
413 {
414 char *locus;
415 int type;
416 };
417
418 struct record event_record[100];
419
420 int event_record_index;
421
422 record_event (locus, type)
423 char *locus;
424 int type;
425 {
426 if (event_record_index == sizeof (event_record) / sizeof (struct record))
427 event_record_index = 0;
428
429 event_record[event_record_index].locus = locus;
430 event_record[event_record_index].type = type;
431 event_record_index++;
432 }
433
434 #endif /* 0 */
435
436
437 \f
438 /* Return the struct x_display_info corresponding to DPY. */
439
440 struct x_display_info *
441 x_display_info_for_display (dpy)
442 Display *dpy;
443 {
444 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
445
446 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
447 if (dpyinfo->display == dpy)
448 return dpyinfo;
449
450 return 0;
451 }
452
453
454 \f
455 /***********************************************************************
456 Starting and ending an update
457 ***********************************************************************/
458
459 /* Start an update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook
460 for update_begin, i.e. it is called when update_begin is called.
461 This function is called prior to calls to x_update_window_begin for
462 each window being updated. Currently, there is nothing to do here
463 because all interesting stuff is done on a window basis. */
464
465 static void
466 x_update_begin (f)
467 struct frame *f;
468 {
469 /* Nothing to do. */
470 }
471
472
473 /* Start update of window W. Set the global variable updated_window
474 to the window being updated and set output_cursor to the cursor
475 position of W. */
476
477 static void
478 x_update_window_begin (w)
479 struct window *w;
480 {
481 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
482 struct x_display_info *display_info = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
483
484 updated_window = w;
485 set_output_cursor (&w->cursor);
486
487 BLOCK_INPUT;
488
489 if (f == display_info->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
490 {
491 /* Don't do highlighting for mouse motion during the update. */
492 display_info->mouse_face_defer = 1;
493
494 /* If F needs to be redrawn, simply forget about any prior mouse
495 highlighting. */
496 if (FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
497 display_info->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
498
499 #if 0 /* Rows in a current matrix containing glyphs in mouse-face have
500 their mouse_face_p flag set, which means that they are always
501 unequal to rows in a desired matrix which never have that
502 flag set. So, rows containing mouse-face glyphs are never
503 scrolled, and we don't have to switch the mouse highlight off
504 here to prevent it from being scrolled. */
505
506 /* Can we tell that this update does not affect the window
507 where the mouse highlight is? If so, no need to turn off.
508 Likewise, don't do anything if the frame is garbaged;
509 in that case, the frame's current matrix that we would use
510 is all wrong, and we will redisplay that line anyway. */
511 if (!NILP (display_info->mouse_face_window)
512 && w == XWINDOW (display_info->mouse_face_window))
513 {
514 int i;
515
516 for (i = 0; i < w->desired_matrix->nrows; ++i)
517 if (MATRIX_ROW_ENABLED_P (w->desired_matrix, i))
518 break;
519
520 if (i < w->desired_matrix->nrows)
521 clear_mouse_face (display_info);
522 }
523 #endif /* 0 */
524 }
525
526 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
527 }
528
529
530 /* Draw a vertical window border from (x,y0) to (x,y1) */
531
532 static void
533 x_draw_vertical_window_border (w, x, y0, y1)
534 struct window *w;
535 int x, y0, y1;
536 {
537 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
538 struct face *face;
539
540 face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, VERTICAL_BORDER_FACE_ID);
541 if (face)
542 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
543 face->foreground);
544
545 XDrawLine (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
546 f->output_data.x->normal_gc, x, y0, x, y1);
547 }
548
549 /* End update of window W (which is equal to updated_window).
550
551 Draw vertical borders between horizontally adjacent windows, and
552 display W's cursor if CURSOR_ON_P is non-zero.
553
554 MOUSE_FACE_OVERWRITTEN_P non-zero means that some row containing
555 glyphs in mouse-face were overwritten. In that case we have to
556 make sure that the mouse-highlight is properly redrawn.
557
558 W may be a menu bar pseudo-window in case we don't have X toolkit
559 support. Such windows don't have a cursor, so don't display it
560 here. */
561
562 static void
563 x_update_window_end (w, cursor_on_p, mouse_face_overwritten_p)
564 struct window *w;
565 int cursor_on_p, mouse_face_overwritten_p;
566 {
567 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (w->frame));
568
569 if (!w->pseudo_window_p)
570 {
571 BLOCK_INPUT;
572
573 if (cursor_on_p)
574 display_and_set_cursor (w, 1, output_cursor.hpos,
575 output_cursor.vpos,
576 output_cursor.x, output_cursor.y);
577
578 if (draw_window_fringes (w, 1))
579 x_draw_vertical_border (w);
580
581 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
582 }
583
584 /* If a row with mouse-face was overwritten, arrange for
585 XTframe_up_to_date to redisplay the mouse highlight. */
586 if (mouse_face_overwritten_p)
587 {
588 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
589 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
590 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
591 }
592
593 updated_window = NULL;
594 }
595
596
597 /* End update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook in
598 update_end. */
599
600 static void
601 x_update_end (f)
602 struct frame *f;
603 {
604 /* Mouse highlight may be displayed again. */
605 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->mouse_face_defer = 0;
606
607 #ifndef XFlush
608 BLOCK_INPUT;
609 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
610 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
611 #endif
612 }
613
614
615 /* This function is called from various places in xdisp.c whenever a
616 complete update has been performed. The global variable
617 updated_window is not available here. */
618
619 static void
620 XTframe_up_to_date (f)
621 struct frame *f;
622 {
623 if (FRAME_X_P (f))
624 {
625 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
626
627 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc
628 || f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
629 {
630 BLOCK_INPUT;
631 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
632 note_mouse_highlight (dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame,
633 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x,
634 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y);
635 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
636 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
637 }
638 }
639 }
640
641
642 /* Draw truncation mark bitmaps, continuation mark bitmaps, overlay
643 arrow bitmaps, or clear the fringes if no bitmaps are required
644 before DESIRED_ROW is made current. The window being updated is
645 found in updated_window. This function It is called from
646 update_window_line only if it is known that there are differences
647 between bitmaps to be drawn between current row and DESIRED_ROW. */
648
649 static void
650 x_after_update_window_line (desired_row)
651 struct glyph_row *desired_row;
652 {
653 struct window *w = updated_window;
654 struct frame *f;
655 int width, height;
656
657 xassert (w);
658
659 if (!desired_row->mode_line_p && !w->pseudo_window_p)
660 desired_row->redraw_fringe_bitmaps_p = 1;
661
662 /* When a window has disappeared, make sure that no rest of
663 full-width rows stays visible in the internal border. Could
664 check here if updated_window is the leftmost/rightmost window,
665 but I guess it's not worth doing since vertically split windows
666 are almost never used, internal border is rarely set, and the
667 overhead is very small. */
668 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
669 && desired_row->full_width_p
670 && (f = XFRAME (w->frame),
671 width = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
672 width != 0)
673 && (height = desired_row->visible_height,
674 height > 0))
675 {
676 int y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, desired_row->y));
677
678 /* Internal border is drawn below the tool bar. */
679 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
680 && w == XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window))
681 y -= width;
682
683 BLOCK_INPUT;
684 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
685 0, y, width, height, False);
686 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
687 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - width,
688 y, width, height, False);
689 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
690 }
691 }
692
693 static void
694 x_draw_fringe_bitmap (w, row, p)
695 struct window *w;
696 struct glyph_row *row;
697 struct draw_fringe_bitmap_params *p;
698 {
699 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
700 Display *display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
701 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
702 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
703 struct face *face = p->face;
704 int rowY;
705
706 /* Must clip because of partially visible lines. */
707 rowY = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, row->y);
708 if (p->y < rowY)
709 {
710 /* Adjust position of "bottom aligned" bitmap on partially
711 visible last row. */
712 int oldY = row->y;
713 int oldVH = row->visible_height;
714 row->visible_height = p->h;
715 row->y -= rowY - p->y;
716 x_clip_to_row (w, row, -1, gc);
717 row->y = oldY;
718 row->visible_height = oldVH;
719 }
720 else
721 x_clip_to_row (w, row, -1, gc);
722
723 if (p->bx >= 0 && !p->overlay_p)
724 {
725 /* In case the same realized face is used for fringes and
726 for something displayed in the text (e.g. face `region' on
727 mono-displays, the fill style may have been changed to
728 FillSolid in x_draw_glyph_string_background. */
729 if (face->stipple)
730 XSetFillStyle (display, face->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
731 else
732 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->background);
733
734 XFillRectangle (display, window, face->gc,
735 p->bx, p->by, p->nx, p->ny);
736
737 if (!face->stipple)
738 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->foreground);
739 }
740
741 if (p->which)
742 {
743 unsigned char *bits;
744 Pixmap pixmap, clipmask = (Pixmap) 0;
745 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f));
746 XGCValues gcv;
747
748 if (p->wd > 8)
749 bits = (unsigned char *)(p->bits + p->dh);
750 else
751 bits = (unsigned char *)p->bits + p->dh;
752
753 /* Draw the bitmap. I believe these small pixmaps can be cached
754 by the server. */
755 pixmap = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display, window, bits, p->wd, p->h,
756 (p->cursor_p
757 ? (p->overlay_p ? face->background
758 : f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
759 : face->foreground),
760 face->background, depth);
761
762 if (p->overlay_p)
763 {
764 clipmask = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display,
765 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window,
766 bits, p->wd, p->h,
767 1, 0, 1);
768 gcv.clip_mask = clipmask;
769 gcv.clip_x_origin = p->x;
770 gcv.clip_y_origin = p->y;
771 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin, &gcv);
772 }
773
774 XCopyArea (display, pixmap, window, gc, 0, 0,
775 p->wd, p->h, p->x, p->y);
776 XFreePixmap (display, pixmap);
777
778 if (p->overlay_p)
779 {
780 gcv.clip_mask = (Pixmap) 0;
781 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask, &gcv);
782 XFreePixmap (display, clipmask);
783 }
784 }
785
786 XSetClipMask (display, gc, None);
787 }
788
789 \f
790
791 /* This is called when starting Emacs and when restarting after
792 suspend. When starting Emacs, no X window is mapped. And nothing
793 must be done to Emacs's own window if it is suspended (though that
794 rarely happens). */
795
796 static void
797 XTset_terminal_modes ()
798 {
799 }
800
801 /* This is called when exiting or suspending Emacs. Exiting will make
802 the X-windows go away, and suspending requires no action. */
803
804 static void
805 XTreset_terminal_modes ()
806 {
807 }
808
809
810 \f
811 /***********************************************************************
812 Display Iterator
813 ***********************************************************************/
814
815 /* Function prototypes of this page. */
816
817 static int x_encode_char P_ ((int, XChar2b *, struct font_info *, int *));
818
819
820 /* Get metrics of character CHAR2B in FONT. Value is null if CHAR2B
821 is not contained in the font. */
822
823 static XCharStruct *
824 x_per_char_metric (font, char2b, font_type)
825 XFontStruct *font;
826 XChar2b *char2b;
827 int font_type; /* unused on X */
828 {
829 /* The result metric information. */
830 XCharStruct *pcm = NULL;
831
832 xassert (font && char2b);
833
834 if (font->per_char != NULL)
835 {
836 if (font->min_byte1 == 0 && font->max_byte1 == 0)
837 {
838 /* min_char_or_byte2 specifies the linear character index
839 corresponding to the first element of the per_char array,
840 max_char_or_byte2 is the index of the last character. A
841 character with non-zero CHAR2B->byte1 is not in the font.
842 A character with byte2 less than min_char_or_byte2 or
843 greater max_char_or_byte2 is not in the font. */
844 if (char2b->byte1 == 0
845 && char2b->byte2 >= font->min_char_or_byte2
846 && char2b->byte2 <= font->max_char_or_byte2)
847 pcm = font->per_char + char2b->byte2 - font->min_char_or_byte2;
848 }
849 else
850 {
851 /* If either min_byte1 or max_byte1 are nonzero, both
852 min_char_or_byte2 and max_char_or_byte2 are less than
853 256, and the 2-byte character index values corresponding
854 to the per_char array element N (counting from 0) are:
855
856 byte1 = N/D + min_byte1
857 byte2 = N\D + min_char_or_byte2
858
859 where:
860
861 D = max_char_or_byte2 - min_char_or_byte2 + 1
862 / = integer division
863 \ = integer modulus */
864 if (char2b->byte1 >= font->min_byte1
865 && char2b->byte1 <= font->max_byte1
866 && char2b->byte2 >= font->min_char_or_byte2
867 && char2b->byte2 <= font->max_char_or_byte2)
868 {
869 pcm = (font->per_char
870 + ((font->max_char_or_byte2 - font->min_char_or_byte2 + 1)
871 * (char2b->byte1 - font->min_byte1))
872 + (char2b->byte2 - font->min_char_or_byte2));
873 }
874 }
875 }
876 else
877 {
878 /* If the per_char pointer is null, all glyphs between the first
879 and last character indexes inclusive have the same
880 information, as given by both min_bounds and max_bounds. */
881 if (char2b->byte2 >= font->min_char_or_byte2
882 && char2b->byte2 <= font->max_char_or_byte2)
883 pcm = &font->max_bounds;
884 }
885
886 return ((pcm == NULL
887 || (pcm->width == 0 && (pcm->rbearing - pcm->lbearing) == 0))
888 ? NULL : pcm);
889 }
890
891
892 /* Encode CHAR2B using encoding information from FONT_INFO. CHAR2B is
893 the two-byte form of C. Encoding is returned in *CHAR2B. */
894
895 static int
896 x_encode_char (c, char2b, font_info, two_byte_p)
897 int c;
898 XChar2b *char2b;
899 struct font_info *font_info;
900 int *two_byte_p;
901 {
902 int charset = CHAR_CHARSET (c);
903 XFontStruct *font = font_info->font;
904
905 /* FONT_INFO may define a scheme by which to encode byte1 and byte2.
906 This may be either a program in a special encoder language or a
907 fixed encoding. */
908 if (font_info->font_encoder)
909 {
910 /* It's a program. */
911 struct ccl_program *ccl = font_info->font_encoder;
912
913 check_ccl_update (ccl);
914 if (CHARSET_DIMENSION (charset) == 1)
915 {
916 ccl->reg[0] = charset;
917 ccl->reg[1] = char2b->byte2;
918 ccl->reg[2] = -1;
919 }
920 else
921 {
922 ccl->reg[0] = charset;
923 ccl->reg[1] = char2b->byte1;
924 ccl->reg[2] = char2b->byte2;
925 }
926
927 ccl_driver (ccl, NULL, NULL, 0, 0, NULL);
928
929 /* We assume that MSBs are appropriately set/reset by CCL
930 program. */
931 if (font->max_byte1 == 0) /* 1-byte font */
932 char2b->byte1 = 0, char2b->byte2 = ccl->reg[1];
933 else
934 char2b->byte1 = ccl->reg[1], char2b->byte2 = ccl->reg[2];
935 }
936 else if (font_info->encoding[charset])
937 {
938 /* Fixed encoding scheme. See fontset.h for the meaning of the
939 encoding numbers. */
940 int enc = font_info->encoding[charset];
941
942 if ((enc == 1 || enc == 2)
943 && CHARSET_DIMENSION (charset) == 2)
944 char2b->byte1 |= 0x80;
945
946 if (enc == 1 || enc == 3)
947 char2b->byte2 |= 0x80;
948 }
949
950 if (two_byte_p)
951 *two_byte_p = ((XFontStruct *) (font_info->font))->max_byte1 > 0;
952
953 return FONT_TYPE_UNKNOWN;
954 }
955
956
957 \f
958 /***********************************************************************
959 Glyph display
960 ***********************************************************************/
961
962
963
964 static void x_set_glyph_string_clipping P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
965 static void x_set_glyph_string_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
966 static void x_draw_glyph_string_background P_ ((struct glyph_string *,
967 int));
968 static void x_draw_glyph_string_foreground P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
969 static void x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
970 static void x_draw_glyph_string_box P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
971 static void x_draw_glyph_string P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
972 static void x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
973 static void x_set_cursor_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
974 static void x_set_mode_line_face_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
975 static void x_set_mouse_face_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
976 static int x_alloc_lighter_color P_ ((struct frame *, Display *, Colormap,
977 unsigned long *, double, int));
978 static void x_setup_relief_color P_ ((struct frame *, struct relief *,
979 double, int, unsigned long));
980 static void x_setup_relief_colors P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
981 static void x_draw_image_glyph_string P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
982 static void x_draw_image_relief P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
983 static void x_draw_image_foreground P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
984 static void x_draw_image_foreground_1 P_ ((struct glyph_string *, Pixmap));
985 static void x_clear_glyph_string_rect P_ ((struct glyph_string *, int,
986 int, int, int));
987 static void x_draw_relief_rect P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int, int,
988 int, int, int, int, int, int,
989 XRectangle *));
990 static void x_draw_box_rect P_ ((struct glyph_string *, int, int, int, int,
991 int, int, int, XRectangle *));
992
993 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
994 static void x_check_font P_ ((struct frame *, XFontStruct *));
995 #endif
996
997
998 /* Set S->gc to a suitable GC for drawing glyph string S in cursor
999 face. */
1000
1001 static void
1002 x_set_cursor_gc (s)
1003 struct glyph_string *s;
1004 {
1005 if (s->font == FRAME_FONT (s->f)
1006 && s->face->background == FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
1007 && s->face->foreground == FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
1008 && !s->cmp)
1009 s->gc = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_gc;
1010 else
1011 {
1012 /* Cursor on non-default face: must merge. */
1013 XGCValues xgcv;
1014 unsigned long mask;
1015
1016 xgcv.background = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
1017 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
1018
1019 /* If the glyph would be invisible, try a different foreground. */
1020 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
1021 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
1022 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
1023 xgcv.foreground = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel;
1024 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
1025 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
1026
1027 /* Make sure the cursor is distinct from text in this face. */
1028 if (xgcv.background == s->face->background
1029 && xgcv.foreground == s->face->foreground)
1030 {
1031 xgcv.background = s->face->foreground;
1032 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
1033 }
1034
1035 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
1036 xgcv.font = s->font->fid;
1037 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1038 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCFont | GCGraphicsExposures;
1039
1040 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
1041 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
1042 mask, &xgcv);
1043 else
1044 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
1045 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
1046
1047 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
1048 }
1049 }
1050
1051
1052 /* Set up S->gc of glyph string S for drawing text in mouse face. */
1053
1054 static void
1055 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s)
1056 struct glyph_string *s;
1057 {
1058 int face_id;
1059 struct face *face;
1060
1061 /* What face has to be used last for the mouse face? */
1062 face_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->mouse_face_face_id;
1063 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
1064 if (face == NULL)
1065 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, MOUSE_FACE_ID);
1066
1067 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1068 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, s->first_glyph->u.ch);
1069 else
1070 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, 0);
1071 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
1072 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1073
1074 /* If font in this face is same as S->font, use it. */
1075 if (s->font == s->face->font)
1076 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1077 else
1078 {
1079 /* Otherwise construct scratch_cursor_gc with values from FACE
1080 but font FONT. */
1081 XGCValues xgcv;
1082 unsigned long mask;
1083
1084 xgcv.background = s->face->background;
1085 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
1086 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
1087 xgcv.font = s->font->fid;
1088 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1089 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCFont | GCGraphicsExposures;
1090
1091 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
1092 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
1093 mask, &xgcv);
1094 else
1095 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
1096 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
1097
1098 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
1099 }
1100
1101 xassert (s->gc != 0);
1102 }
1103
1104
1105 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S to a GC suitable for drawing a mode line.
1106 Faces to use in the mode line have already been computed when the
1107 matrix was built, so there isn't much to do, here. */
1108
1109 static INLINE void
1110 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s)
1111 struct glyph_string *s;
1112 {
1113 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1114 }
1115
1116
1117 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S for drawing that glyph string. Set
1118 S->stippled_p to a non-zero value if the face of S has a stipple
1119 pattern. */
1120
1121 static INLINE void
1122 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s)
1123 struct glyph_string *s;
1124 {
1125 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1126
1127 if (s->hl == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT)
1128 {
1129 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1130 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1131 }
1132 else if (s->hl == DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO)
1133 {
1134 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s);
1135 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1136 }
1137 else if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
1138 {
1139 x_set_cursor_gc (s);
1140 s->stippled_p = 0;
1141 }
1142 else if (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE)
1143 {
1144 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
1145 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1146 }
1147 else if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
1148 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
1149 {
1150 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1151 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1152 }
1153 else
1154 {
1155 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1156 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1157 }
1158
1159 /* GC must have been set. */
1160 xassert (s->gc != 0);
1161 }
1162
1163
1164 /* Set clipping for output of glyph string S. S may be part of a mode
1165 line or menu if we don't have X toolkit support. */
1166
1167 static INLINE void
1168 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s)
1169 struct glyph_string *s;
1170 {
1171 XRectangle r;
1172 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
1173 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
1174 }
1175
1176
1177 /* RIF:
1178 Compute left and right overhang of glyph string S. If S is a glyph
1179 string for a composition, assume overhangs don't exist. */
1180
1181 static void
1182 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (s)
1183 struct glyph_string *s;
1184 {
1185 if (s->cmp == NULL
1186 && s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1187 {
1188 XCharStruct cs;
1189 int direction, font_ascent, font_descent;
1190 XTextExtents16 (s->font, s->char2b, s->nchars, &direction,
1191 &font_ascent, &font_descent, &cs);
1192 s->right_overhang = cs.rbearing > cs.width ? cs.rbearing - cs.width : 0;
1193 s->left_overhang = cs.lbearing < 0 ? -cs.lbearing : 0;
1194 }
1195 }
1196
1197
1198 /* Fill rectangle X, Y, W, H with background color of glyph string S. */
1199
1200 static INLINE void
1201 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h)
1202 struct glyph_string *s;
1203 int x, y, w, h;
1204 {
1205 XGCValues xgcv;
1206 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
1207 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
1208 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
1209 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
1210 }
1211
1212
1213 /* Draw the background of glyph_string S. If S->background_filled_p
1214 is non-zero don't draw it. FORCE_P non-zero means draw the
1215 background even if it wouldn't be drawn normally. This is used
1216 when a string preceding S draws into the background of S, or S
1217 contains the first component of a composition. */
1218
1219 static void
1220 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, force_p)
1221 struct glyph_string *s;
1222 int force_p;
1223 {
1224 /* Nothing to do if background has already been drawn or if it
1225 shouldn't be drawn in the first place. */
1226 if (!s->background_filled_p)
1227 {
1228 int box_line_width = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
1229
1230 if (s->stippled_p)
1231 {
1232 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
1233 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
1234 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x,
1235 s->y + box_line_width,
1236 s->background_width,
1237 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1238 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
1239 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1240 }
1241 else if (FONT_HEIGHT (s->font) < s->height - 2 * box_line_width
1242 || s->font_not_found_p
1243 || s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
1244 || force_p)
1245 {
1246 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, s->x, s->y + box_line_width,
1247 s->background_width,
1248 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1249 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1250 }
1251 }
1252 }
1253
1254
1255 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S. */
1256
1257 static void
1258 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s)
1259 struct glyph_string *s;
1260 {
1261 int i, x;
1262
1263 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1264 of S to the right of that box line. */
1265 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1266 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1267 x = s->x + abs (s->face->box_line_width);
1268 else
1269 x = s->x;
1270
1271 /* Draw characters of S as rectangles if S's font could not be
1272 loaded. */
1273 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1274 {
1275 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
1276 {
1277 struct glyph *g = s->first_glyph + i;
1278 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window,
1279 s->gc, x, s->y, g->pixel_width - 1,
1280 s->height - 1);
1281 x += g->pixel_width;
1282 }
1283 }
1284 else
1285 {
1286 char *char1b = (char *) s->char2b;
1287 int boff = s->font_info->baseline_offset;
1288
1289 if (s->font_info->vertical_centering)
1290 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (s->font, s->f) - boff;
1291
1292 /* If we can use 8-bit functions, condense S->char2b. */
1293 if (!s->two_byte_p)
1294 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
1295 char1b[i] = s->char2b[i].byte2;
1296
1297 /* Draw text with XDrawString if background has already been
1298 filled. Otherwise, use XDrawImageString. (Note that
1299 XDrawImageString is usually faster than XDrawString.) Always
1300 use XDrawImageString when drawing the cursor so that there is
1301 no chance that characters under a box cursor are invisible. */
1302 if (s->for_overlaps_p
1303 || (s->background_filled_p && s->hl != DRAW_CURSOR))
1304 {
1305 /* Draw characters with 16-bit or 8-bit functions. */
1306 if (s->two_byte_p)
1307 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
1308 s->ybase - boff, s->char2b, s->nchars);
1309 else
1310 XDrawString (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
1311 s->ybase - boff, char1b, s->nchars);
1312 }
1313 else
1314 {
1315 if (s->two_byte_p)
1316 XDrawImageString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
1317 s->ybase - boff, s->char2b, s->nchars);
1318 else
1319 XDrawImageString (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
1320 s->ybase - boff, char1b, s->nchars);
1321 }
1322
1323 if (s->face->overstrike)
1324 {
1325 /* For overstriking (to simulate bold-face), draw the
1326 characters again shifted to the right by one pixel. */
1327 if (s->two_byte_p)
1328 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x + 1,
1329 s->ybase - boff, s->char2b, s->nchars);
1330 else
1331 XDrawString (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x + 1,
1332 s->ybase - boff, char1b, s->nchars);
1333 }
1334 }
1335 }
1336
1337 /* Draw the foreground of composite glyph string S. */
1338
1339 static void
1340 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s)
1341 struct glyph_string *s;
1342 {
1343 int i, x;
1344
1345 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1346 of S to the right of that box line. */
1347 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1348 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1349 x = s->x + abs (s->face->box_line_width);
1350 else
1351 x = s->x;
1352
1353 /* S is a glyph string for a composition. S->gidx is the index of
1354 the first character drawn for glyphs of this composition.
1355 S->gidx == 0 means we are drawing the very first character of
1356 this composition. */
1357
1358 /* Draw a rectangle for the composition if the font for the very
1359 first character of the composition could not be loaded. */
1360 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1361 {
1362 if (s->gidx == 0)
1363 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, s->y,
1364 s->width - 1, s->height - 1);
1365 }
1366 else
1367 {
1368 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++, ++s->gidx)
1369 {
1370 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
1371 x + s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2],
1372 s->ybase - s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2 + 1],
1373 s->char2b + i, 1);
1374 if (s->face->overstrike)
1375 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
1376 x + s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2] + 1,
1377 s->ybase - s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2 + 1],
1378 s->char2b + i, 1);
1379 }
1380 }
1381 }
1382
1383
1384 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
1385
1386 static struct frame *x_frame_of_widget P_ ((Widget));
1387 static Boolean cvt_string_to_pixel P_ ((Display *, XrmValue *, Cardinal *,
1388 XrmValue *, XrmValue *, XtPointer *));
1389 static void cvt_pixel_dtor P_ ((XtAppContext, XrmValue *, XtPointer,
1390 XrmValue *, Cardinal *));
1391
1392
1393 /* Return the frame on which widget WIDGET is used.. Abort if frame
1394 cannot be determined. */
1395
1396 static struct frame *
1397 x_frame_of_widget (widget)
1398 Widget widget;
1399 {
1400 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
1401 Lisp_Object tail;
1402 struct frame *f;
1403
1404 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (XtDisplay (widget));
1405
1406 /* Find the top-level shell of the widget. Note that this function
1407 can be called when the widget is not yet realized, so XtWindow
1408 (widget) == 0. That's the reason we can't simply use
1409 x_any_window_to_frame. */
1410 while (!XtIsTopLevelShell (widget))
1411 widget = XtParent (widget);
1412
1413 /* Look for a frame with that top-level widget. Allocate the color
1414 on that frame to get the right gamma correction value. */
1415 for (tail = Vframe_list; GC_CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
1416 if (GC_FRAMEP (XCAR (tail))
1417 && (f = XFRAME (XCAR (tail)),
1418 (f->output_data.nothing != 1
1419 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo))
1420 && f->output_data.x->widget == widget)
1421 return f;
1422
1423 abort ();
1424 }
1425
1426
1427 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on the screen and display of
1428 widget WIDGET in colormap CMAP. If an exact match cannot be
1429 allocated, try the nearest color available. Value is non-zero
1430 if successful. This is called from lwlib. */
1431
1432 int
1433 x_alloc_nearest_color_for_widget (widget, cmap, color)
1434 Widget widget;
1435 Colormap cmap;
1436 XColor *color;
1437 {
1438 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1439 return x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, color);
1440 }
1441
1442
1443 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1444 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1445 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1446 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1447 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1448 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1449
1450 int
1451 x_alloc_lighter_color_for_widget (widget, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta)
1452 Widget widget;
1453 Display *display;
1454 Colormap cmap;
1455 unsigned long *pixel;
1456 double factor;
1457 int delta;
1458 {
1459 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1460 return x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta);
1461 }
1462
1463
1464 /* Structure specifying which arguments should be passed by Xt to
1465 cvt_string_to_pixel. We want the widget's screen and colormap. */
1466
1467 static XtConvertArgRec cvt_string_to_pixel_args[] =
1468 {
1469 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.screen),
1470 sizeof (Screen *)},
1471 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.colormap),
1472 sizeof (Colormap)}
1473 };
1474
1475
1476 /* The address of this variable is returned by
1477 cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1478
1479 static Pixel cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1480
1481
1482 /* Convert a color name to a pixel color.
1483
1484 DPY is the display we are working on.
1485
1486 ARGS is an array of *NARGS XrmValue structures holding additional
1487 information about the widget for which the conversion takes place.
1488 The contents of this array are determined by the specification
1489 in cvt_string_to_pixel_args.
1490
1491 FROM is a pointer to an XrmValue which points to the color name to
1492 convert. TO is an XrmValue in which to return the pixel color.
1493
1494 CLOSURE_RET is a pointer to user-data, in which we record if
1495 we allocated the color or not.
1496
1497 Value is True if successful, False otherwise. */
1498
1499 static Boolean
1500 cvt_string_to_pixel (dpy, args, nargs, from, to, closure_ret)
1501 Display *dpy;
1502 XrmValue *args;
1503 Cardinal *nargs;
1504 XrmValue *from, *to;
1505 XtPointer *closure_ret;
1506 {
1507 Screen *screen;
1508 Colormap cmap;
1509 Pixel pixel;
1510 String color_name;
1511 XColor color;
1512
1513 if (*nargs != 2)
1514 {
1515 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1516 "wrongParameters", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1517 "XtToolkitError",
1518 "Screen and colormap args required", NULL, NULL);
1519 return False;
1520 }
1521
1522 screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1523 cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1524 color_name = (String) from->addr;
1525
1526 if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultBackground) == 0)
1527 {
1528 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1529 pixel = WhitePixelOfScreen (screen);
1530 }
1531 else if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultForeground) == 0)
1532 {
1533 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1534 pixel = BlackPixelOfScreen (screen);
1535 }
1536 else if (XParseColor (dpy, cmap, color_name, &color)
1537 && x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy, cmap, &color))
1538 {
1539 pixel = color.pixel;
1540 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) True;
1541 }
1542 else
1543 {
1544 String params[1];
1545 Cardinal nparams = 1;
1546
1547 params[0] = color_name;
1548 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1549 "badValue", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1550 "XtToolkitError", "Invalid color `%s'",
1551 params, &nparams);
1552 return False;
1553 }
1554
1555 if (to->addr != NULL)
1556 {
1557 if (to->size < sizeof (Pixel))
1558 {
1559 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1560 return False;
1561 }
1562
1563 *(Pixel *) to->addr = pixel;
1564 }
1565 else
1566 {
1567 cvt_string_to_pixel_value = pixel;
1568 to->addr = (XtPointer) &cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1569 }
1570
1571 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1572 return True;
1573 }
1574
1575
1576 /* Free a pixel color which was previously allocated via
1577 cvt_string_to_pixel. This is registered as the destructor
1578 for this type of resource via XtSetTypeConverter.
1579
1580 APP is the application context in which we work.
1581
1582 TO is a pointer to an XrmValue holding the color to free.
1583 CLOSURE is the value we stored in CLOSURE_RET for this color
1584 in cvt_string_to_pixel.
1585
1586 ARGS and NARGS are like for cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1587
1588 static void
1589 cvt_pixel_dtor (app, to, closure, args, nargs)
1590 XtAppContext app;
1591 XrmValuePtr to;
1592 XtPointer closure;
1593 XrmValuePtr args;
1594 Cardinal *nargs;
1595 {
1596 if (*nargs != 2)
1597 {
1598 XtAppWarningMsg (app, "wrongParameters", "cvt_pixel_dtor",
1599 "XtToolkitError",
1600 "Screen and colormap arguments required",
1601 NULL, NULL);
1602 }
1603 else if (closure != NULL)
1604 {
1605 /* We did allocate the pixel, so free it. */
1606 Screen *screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1607 Colormap cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1608 x_free_dpy_colors (DisplayOfScreen (screen), screen, cmap,
1609 (Pixel *) to->addr, 1);
1610 }
1611 }
1612
1613
1614 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
1615
1616
1617 /* Value is an array of XColor structures for the contents of the
1618 color map of display DPY. Set *NCELLS to the size of the array.
1619 Note that this probably shouldn't be called for large color maps,
1620 say a 24-bit TrueColor map. */
1621
1622 static const XColor *
1623 x_color_cells (dpy, ncells)
1624 Display *dpy;
1625 int *ncells;
1626 {
1627 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1628
1629 if (dpyinfo->color_cells == NULL)
1630 {
1631 Screen *screen = dpyinfo->screen;
1632 int i;
1633
1634 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells
1635 = XDisplayCells (dpy, XScreenNumberOfScreen (screen));
1636 dpyinfo->color_cells
1637 = (XColor *) xmalloc (dpyinfo->ncolor_cells
1638 * sizeof *dpyinfo->color_cells);
1639
1640 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells; ++i)
1641 dpyinfo->color_cells[i].pixel = i;
1642
1643 XQueryColors (dpy, dpyinfo->cmap,
1644 dpyinfo->color_cells, dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1645 }
1646
1647 *ncells = dpyinfo->ncolor_cells;
1648 return dpyinfo->color_cells;
1649 }
1650
1651
1652 /* On frame F, translate pixel colors to RGB values for the NCOLORS
1653 colors in COLORS. Use cached information, if available. */
1654
1655 void
1656 x_query_colors (f, colors, ncolors)
1657 struct frame *f;
1658 XColor *colors;
1659 int ncolors;
1660 {
1661 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1662
1663 if (dpyinfo->color_cells)
1664 {
1665 int i;
1666 for (i = 0; i < ncolors; ++i)
1667 {
1668 unsigned long pixel = colors[i].pixel;
1669 xassert (pixel < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1670 xassert (dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel].pixel == pixel);
1671 colors[i] = dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel];
1672 }
1673 }
1674 else
1675 XQueryColors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), colors, ncolors);
1676 }
1677
1678
1679 /* On frame F, translate pixel color to RGB values for the color in
1680 COLOR. Use cached information, if available. */
1681
1682 void
1683 x_query_color (f, color)
1684 struct frame *f;
1685 XColor *color;
1686 {
1687 x_query_colors (f, color, 1);
1688 }
1689
1690
1691 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on DISPLAY, colormap CMAP. If an
1692 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1693 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1694 allocated. */
1695
1696 static int
1697 x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy, cmap, color)
1698 Display *dpy;
1699 Colormap cmap;
1700 XColor *color;
1701 {
1702 int rc;
1703
1704 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1705 if (rc == 0)
1706 {
1707 /* If we got to this point, the colormap is full, so we're going
1708 to try to get the next closest color. The algorithm used is
1709 a least-squares matching, which is what X uses for closest
1710 color matching with StaticColor visuals. */
1711 int nearest, i;
1712 unsigned long nearest_delta = ~0;
1713 int ncells;
1714 const XColor *cells = x_color_cells (dpy, &ncells);
1715
1716 for (nearest = i = 0; i < ncells; ++i)
1717 {
1718 long dred = (color->red >> 8) - (cells[i].red >> 8);
1719 long dgreen = (color->green >> 8) - (cells[i].green >> 8);
1720 long dblue = (color->blue >> 8) - (cells[i].blue >> 8);
1721 unsigned long delta = dred * dred + dgreen * dgreen + dblue * dblue;
1722
1723 if (delta < nearest_delta)
1724 {
1725 nearest = i;
1726 nearest_delta = delta;
1727 }
1728 }
1729
1730 color->red = cells[nearest].red;
1731 color->green = cells[nearest].green;
1732 color->blue = cells[nearest].blue;
1733 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1734 }
1735 else
1736 {
1737 /* If allocation succeeded, and the allocated pixel color is not
1738 equal to a cached pixel color recorded earlier, there was a
1739 change in the colormap, so clear the color cache. */
1740 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1741 XColor *cached_color;
1742
1743 if (dpyinfo->color_cells
1744 && (cached_color = &dpyinfo->color_cells[color->pixel],
1745 (cached_color->red != color->red
1746 || cached_color->blue != color->blue
1747 || cached_color->green != color->green)))
1748 {
1749 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
1750 dpyinfo->color_cells = NULL;
1751 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells = 0;
1752 }
1753 }
1754
1755 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1756 if (rc)
1757 register_color (color->pixel);
1758 #endif /* DEBUG_X_COLORS */
1759
1760 return rc;
1761 }
1762
1763
1764 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on frame F, colormap CMAP. If an
1765 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1766 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1767 allocated. */
1768
1769 int
1770 x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, color)
1771 struct frame *f;
1772 Colormap cmap;
1773 XColor *color;
1774 {
1775 gamma_correct (f, color);
1776 return x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), cmap, color);
1777 }
1778
1779
1780 /* Allocate color PIXEL on frame F. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1781 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1782 get color reference counts right. */
1783
1784 unsigned long
1785 x_copy_color (f, pixel)
1786 struct frame *f;
1787 unsigned long pixel;
1788 {
1789 XColor color;
1790
1791 color.pixel = pixel;
1792 BLOCK_INPUT;
1793 x_query_color (f, &color);
1794 XAllocColor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), &color);
1795 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
1796 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1797 register_color (pixel);
1798 #endif
1799 return color.pixel;
1800 }
1801
1802
1803 /* Allocate color PIXEL on display DPY. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1804 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1805 get color reference counts right. */
1806
1807 unsigned long
1808 x_copy_dpy_color (dpy, cmap, pixel)
1809 Display *dpy;
1810 Colormap cmap;
1811 unsigned long pixel;
1812 {
1813 XColor color;
1814
1815 color.pixel = pixel;
1816 BLOCK_INPUT;
1817 XQueryColor (dpy, cmap, &color);
1818 XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, &color);
1819 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
1820 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1821 register_color (pixel);
1822 #endif
1823 return color.pixel;
1824 }
1825
1826
1827 /* Brightness beyond which a color won't have its highlight brightness
1828 boosted.
1829
1830 Nominally, highlight colors for `3d' faces are calculated by
1831 brightening an object's color by a constant scale factor, but this
1832 doesn't yield good results for dark colors, so for colors who's
1833 brightness is less than this value (on a scale of 0-65535) have an
1834 use an additional additive factor.
1835
1836 The value here is set so that the default menu-bar/mode-line color
1837 (grey75) will not have its highlights changed at all. */
1838 #define HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT 48000
1839
1840
1841 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1842 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1843 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1844 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1845 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1846 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1847
1848 static int
1849 x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta)
1850 struct frame *f;
1851 Display *display;
1852 Colormap cmap;
1853 unsigned long *pixel;
1854 double factor;
1855 int delta;
1856 {
1857 XColor color, new;
1858 long bright;
1859 int success_p;
1860
1861 /* Get RGB color values. */
1862 color.pixel = *pixel;
1863 x_query_color (f, &color);
1864
1865 /* Change RGB values by specified FACTOR. Avoid overflow! */
1866 xassert (factor >= 0);
1867 new.red = min (0xffff, factor * color.red);
1868 new.green = min (0xffff, factor * color.green);
1869 new.blue = min (0xffff, factor * color.blue);
1870
1871 /* Calculate brightness of COLOR. */
1872 bright = (2 * color.red + 3 * color.green + color.blue) / 6;
1873
1874 /* We only boost colors that are darker than
1875 HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT. */
1876 if (bright < HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT)
1877 /* Make an additive adjustment to NEW, because it's dark enough so
1878 that scaling by FACTOR alone isn't enough. */
1879 {
1880 /* How far below the limit this color is (0 - 1, 1 being darker). */
1881 double dimness = 1 - (double)bright / HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT;
1882 /* The additive adjustment. */
1883 int min_delta = delta * dimness * factor / 2;
1884
1885 if (factor < 1)
1886 {
1887 new.red = max (0, new.red - min_delta);
1888 new.green = max (0, new.green - min_delta);
1889 new.blue = max (0, new.blue - min_delta);
1890 }
1891 else
1892 {
1893 new.red = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.red);
1894 new.green = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.green);
1895 new.blue = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.blue);
1896 }
1897 }
1898
1899 /* Try to allocate the color. */
1900 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1901 if (success_p)
1902 {
1903 if (new.pixel == *pixel)
1904 {
1905 /* If we end up with the same color as before, try adding
1906 delta to the RGB values. */
1907 x_free_colors (f, &new.pixel, 1);
1908
1909 new.red = min (0xffff, delta + color.red);
1910 new.green = min (0xffff, delta + color.green);
1911 new.blue = min (0xffff, delta + color.blue);
1912 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1913 }
1914 else
1915 success_p = 1;
1916 *pixel = new.pixel;
1917 }
1918
1919 return success_p;
1920 }
1921
1922
1923 /* Set up the foreground color for drawing relief lines of glyph
1924 string S. RELIEF is a pointer to a struct relief containing the GC
1925 with which lines will be drawn. Use a color that is FACTOR or
1926 DELTA lighter or darker than the relief's background which is found
1927 in S->f->output_data.x->relief_background. If such a color cannot
1928 be allocated, use DEFAULT_PIXEL, instead. */
1929
1930 static void
1931 x_setup_relief_color (f, relief, factor, delta, default_pixel)
1932 struct frame *f;
1933 struct relief *relief;
1934 double factor;
1935 int delta;
1936 unsigned long default_pixel;
1937 {
1938 XGCValues xgcv;
1939 struct x_output *di = f->output_data.x;
1940 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCLineWidth | GCGraphicsExposures;
1941 unsigned long pixel;
1942 unsigned long background = di->relief_background;
1943 Colormap cmap = FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f);
1944 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1945 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
1946
1947 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1948 xgcv.line_width = 1;
1949
1950 /* Free previously allocated color. The color cell will be reused
1951 when it has been freed as many times as it was allocated, so this
1952 doesn't affect faces using the same colors. */
1953 if (relief->gc
1954 && relief->allocated_p)
1955 {
1956 x_free_colors (f, &relief->pixel, 1);
1957 relief->allocated_p = 0;
1958 }
1959
1960 /* Allocate new color. */
1961 xgcv.foreground = default_pixel;
1962 pixel = background;
1963 if (dpyinfo->n_planes != 1
1964 && x_alloc_lighter_color (f, dpy, cmap, &pixel, factor, delta))
1965 {
1966 relief->allocated_p = 1;
1967 xgcv.foreground = relief->pixel = pixel;
1968 }
1969
1970 if (relief->gc == 0)
1971 {
1972 xgcv.stipple = dpyinfo->gray;
1973 mask |= GCStipple;
1974 relief->gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), mask, &xgcv);
1975 }
1976 else
1977 XChangeGC (dpy, relief->gc, mask, &xgcv);
1978 }
1979
1980
1981 /* Set up colors for the relief lines around glyph string S. */
1982
1983 static void
1984 x_setup_relief_colors (s)
1985 struct glyph_string *s;
1986 {
1987 struct x_output *di = s->f->output_data.x;
1988 unsigned long color;
1989
1990 if (s->face->use_box_color_for_shadows_p)
1991 color = s->face->box_color;
1992 else if (s->first_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH
1993 && s->img->pixmap
1994 && !IMAGE_BACKGROUND_TRANSPARENT (s->img, s->f, 0))
1995 color = IMAGE_BACKGROUND (s->img, s->f, 0);
1996 else
1997 {
1998 XGCValues xgcv;
1999
2000 /* Get the background color of the face. */
2001 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCBackground, &xgcv);
2002 color = xgcv.background;
2003 }
2004
2005 if (di->white_relief.gc == 0
2006 || color != di->relief_background)
2007 {
2008 di->relief_background = color;
2009 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->white_relief, 1.2, 0x8000,
2010 WHITE_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
2011 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->black_relief, 0.6, 0x4000,
2012 BLACK_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
2013 }
2014 }
2015
2016
2017 /* Draw a relief on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X,
2018 TOP_Y, RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the relief
2019 to draw, it must be >= 0. RAISED_P non-zero means draw a raised
2020 relief. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the left side of
2021 the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the right
2022 side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping rectangle to use
2023 when drawing. */
2024
2025 static void
2026 x_draw_relief_rect (f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2027 raised_p, top_p, bot_p, left_p, right_p, clip_rect)
2028 struct frame *f;
2029 int left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width;
2030 int top_p, bot_p, left_p, right_p, raised_p;
2031 XRectangle *clip_rect;
2032 {
2033 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
2034 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
2035 int i;
2036 GC gc;
2037
2038 if (raised_p)
2039 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2040 else
2041 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2042 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2043
2044 /* Top. */
2045 if (top_p)
2046 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2047 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2048 left_x + i * left_p, top_y + i,
2049 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, top_y + i);
2050
2051 /* Left. */
2052 if (left_p)
2053 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2054 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2055 left_x + i, top_y + i, left_x + i, bottom_y - i + 1);
2056
2057 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2058 if (raised_p)
2059 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2060 else
2061 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2062 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2063
2064 /* Bottom. */
2065 if (bot_p)
2066 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2067 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2068 left_x + i * left_p, bottom_y - i,
2069 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, bottom_y - i);
2070
2071 /* Right. */
2072 if (right_p)
2073 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2074 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2075 right_x - i, top_y + i + 1, right_x - i, bottom_y - i);
2076
2077 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2078 }
2079
2080
2081 /* Draw a box on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X, TOP_Y,
2082 RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the lines to
2083 draw, it must be >= 0. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a line on the
2084 left side of the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a line
2085 on the right side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping
2086 rectangle to use when drawing. */
2087
2088 static void
2089 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2090 left_p, right_p, clip_rect)
2091 struct glyph_string *s;
2092 int left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width, left_p, right_p;
2093 XRectangle *clip_rect;
2094 {
2095 XGCValues xgcv;
2096
2097 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2098 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->box_color);
2099 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2100
2101 /* Top. */
2102 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2103 left_x, top_y, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2104
2105 /* Left. */
2106 if (left_p)
2107 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2108 left_x, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2109
2110 /* Bottom. */
2111 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2112 left_x, bottom_y - width + 1, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2113
2114 /* Right. */
2115 if (right_p)
2116 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2117 right_x - width + 1, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2118
2119 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2120 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2121 }
2122
2123
2124 /* Draw a box around glyph string S. */
2125
2126 static void
2127 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s)
2128 struct glyph_string *s;
2129 {
2130 int width, left_x, right_x, top_y, bottom_y, last_x, raised_p;
2131 int left_p, right_p;
2132 struct glyph *last_glyph;
2133 XRectangle clip_rect;
2134
2135 last_x = ((s->row->full_width_p && !s->w->pseudo_window_p)
2136 ? WINDOW_RIGHT_EDGE_X (s->w)
2137 : window_box_right (s->w, s->area));
2138
2139 /* The glyph that may have a right box line. */
2140 last_glyph = (s->cmp || s->img
2141 ? s->first_glyph
2142 : s->first_glyph + s->nchars - 1);
2143
2144 width = abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2145 raised_p = s->face->box == FACE_RAISED_BOX;
2146 left_x = s->x;
2147 right_x = (s->row->full_width_p && s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
2148 ? last_x - 1
2149 : min (last_x, s->x + s->background_width) - 1);
2150 top_y = s->y;
2151 bottom_y = top_y + s->height - 1;
2152
2153 left_p = (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2154 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2155 && (s->prev == NULL
2156 || s->prev->hl != s->hl)));
2157 right_p = (last_glyph->right_box_line_p
2158 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2159 && (s->next == NULL
2160 || s->next->hl != s->hl)));
2161
2162 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2163
2164 if (s->face->box == FACE_SIMPLE_BOX)
2165 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2166 left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2167 else
2168 {
2169 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2170 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y,
2171 width, raised_p, 1, 1, left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2172 }
2173 }
2174
2175
2176 /* Draw foreground of image glyph string S. */
2177
2178 static void
2179 x_draw_image_foreground (s)
2180 struct glyph_string *s;
2181 {
2182 int x = s->x;
2183 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2184
2185 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2186 right of that line. */
2187 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2188 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2189 && s->slice.x == 0)
2190 x += abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2191
2192 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2193 by that margin. */
2194 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2195 x += s->img->hmargin;
2196 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2197 y += s->img->vmargin;
2198
2199 if (s->img->pixmap)
2200 {
2201 if (s->img->mask)
2202 {
2203 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2204 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2205 trust on the shape extension to be available
2206 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2207 manually. */
2208 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2209 | GCFunction);
2210 XGCValues xgcv;
2211 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2212
2213 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2214 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x;
2215 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y;
2216 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2217 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2218
2219 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2220 image_rect.x = x;
2221 image_rect.y = y;
2222 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2223 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2224 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2225 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2226 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2227 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2228 }
2229 else
2230 {
2231 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2232
2233 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2234 image_rect.x = x;
2235 image_rect.y = y;
2236 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2237 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2238 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2239 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2240 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2241 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2242
2243 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2244 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2245 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2246 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2247 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2248 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2249 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2250 {
2251 int r = s->img->relief;
2252 if (r < 0) r = -r;
2253 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2254 x - r, y - r,
2255 s->slice.width + r*2 - 1,
2256 s->slice.height + r*2 - 1);
2257 }
2258 }
2259 }
2260 else
2261 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2262 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y,
2263 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2264 }
2265
2266
2267 /* Draw a relief around the image glyph string S. */
2268
2269 static void
2270 x_draw_image_relief (s)
2271 struct glyph_string *s;
2272 {
2273 int x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p;
2274 XRectangle r;
2275 int x = s->x;
2276 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2277
2278 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2279 right of that line. */
2280 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2281 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2282 && s->slice.x == 0)
2283 x += abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2284
2285 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2286 by that margin. */
2287 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2288 x += s->img->hmargin;
2289 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2290 y += s->img->vmargin;
2291
2292 if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN
2293 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED)
2294 {
2295 thick = tool_bar_button_relief >= 0 ? tool_bar_button_relief : DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_RELIEF;
2296 raised_p = s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
2297 }
2298 else
2299 {
2300 thick = abs (s->img->relief);
2301 raised_p = s->img->relief > 0;
2302 }
2303
2304 x0 = x - thick;
2305 y0 = y - thick;
2306 x1 = x + s->slice.width + thick - 1;
2307 y1 = y + s->slice.height + thick - 1;
2308
2309 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2310 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2311 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p,
2312 s->slice.y == 0,
2313 s->slice.y + s->slice.height == s->img->height,
2314 s->slice.x == 0,
2315 s->slice.x + s->slice.width == s->img->width,
2316 &r);
2317 }
2318
2319
2320 /* Draw the foreground of image glyph string S to PIXMAP. */
2321
2322 static void
2323 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap)
2324 struct glyph_string *s;
2325 Pixmap pixmap;
2326 {
2327 int x = 0;
2328 int y = s->ybase - s->y - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2329
2330 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2331 right of that line. */
2332 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2333 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2334 && s->slice.x == 0)
2335 x += abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2336
2337 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2338 by that margin. */
2339 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2340 x += s->img->hmargin;
2341 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2342 y += s->img->vmargin;
2343
2344 if (s->img->pixmap)
2345 {
2346 if (s->img->mask)
2347 {
2348 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2349 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2350 trust on the shape extension to be available
2351 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2352 manually. */
2353 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2354 | GCFunction);
2355 XGCValues xgcv;
2356
2357 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2358 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x - s->slice.x;
2359 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y - s->slice.y;
2360 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2361 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2362
2363 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2364 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2365 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2366 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2367 }
2368 else
2369 {
2370 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2371 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2372 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2373
2374 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2375 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2376 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2377 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2378 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2379 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2380 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2381 {
2382 int r = s->img->relief;
2383 if (r < 0) r = -r;
2384 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x - r, y - r,
2385 s->slice.width + r*2 - 1,
2386 s->slice.height + r*2 - 1);
2387 }
2388 }
2389 }
2390 else
2391 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2392 XDrawRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc, x, y,
2393 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2394 }
2395
2396
2397 /* Draw part of the background of glyph string S. X, Y, W, and H
2398 give the rectangle to draw. */
2399
2400 static void
2401 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, w, h)
2402 struct glyph_string *s;
2403 int x, y, w, h;
2404 {
2405 if (s->stippled_p)
2406 {
2407 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2408 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2409 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
2410 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2411 }
2412 else
2413 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h);
2414 }
2415
2416
2417 /* Draw image glyph string S.
2418
2419 s->y
2420 s->x +-------------------------
2421 | s->face->box
2422 |
2423 | +-------------------------
2424 | | s->img->margin
2425 | |
2426 | | +-------------------
2427 | | | the image
2428
2429 */
2430
2431 static void
2432 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s)
2433 struct glyph_string *s;
2434 {
2435 int box_line_hwidth = abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2436 int box_line_vwidth = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
2437 int height;
2438 Pixmap pixmap = None;
2439
2440 height = s->height;
2441 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2442 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2443 if (s->slice.y + s->slice.height >= s->img->height)
2444 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2445
2446 /* Fill background with face under the image. Do it only if row is
2447 taller than image or if image has a clip mask to reduce
2448 flickering. */
2449 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2450 if (height > s->slice.height
2451 || s->img->hmargin
2452 || s->img->vmargin
2453 || s->img->mask
2454 || s->img->pixmap == 0
2455 || s->width != s->background_width)
2456 {
2457 if (s->img->mask)
2458 {
2459 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. Fill it
2460 with the background color. Copy the image to it, using
2461 its mask. Copy the temporary pixmap to the display. */
2462 Screen *screen = FRAME_X_SCREEN (s->f);
2463 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (screen);
2464
2465 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. */
2466 pixmap = XCreatePixmap (s->display, s->window,
2467 s->background_width,
2468 s->height, depth);
2469
2470 /* Don't clip in the following because we're working on the
2471 pixmap. */
2472 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2473
2474 /* Fill the pixmap with the background color/stipple. */
2475 if (s->stippled_p)
2476 {
2477 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2478 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2479 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2480 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2481 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2482 }
2483 else
2484 {
2485 XGCValues xgcv;
2486 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground,
2487 &xgcv);
2488 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
2489 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2490 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2491 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2492 }
2493 }
2494 else
2495 {
2496 int x = s->x;
2497 int y = s->y;
2498
2499 if (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2500 && s->slice.x == 0)
2501 x += box_line_hwidth;
2502
2503 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2504 y += box_line_vwidth;
2505
2506 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, s->background_width, height);
2507 }
2508
2509 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2510 }
2511
2512 /* Draw the foreground. */
2513 if (pixmap != None)
2514 {
2515 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap);
2516 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2517 XCopyArea (s->display, pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2518 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height, s->x, s->y);
2519 XFreePixmap (s->display, pixmap);
2520 }
2521 else
2522 x_draw_image_foreground (s);
2523
2524 /* If we must draw a relief around the image, do it. */
2525 if (s->img->relief
2526 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
2527 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
2528 x_draw_image_relief (s);
2529 }
2530
2531
2532 /* Draw stretch glyph string S. */
2533
2534 static void
2535 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s)
2536 struct glyph_string *s;
2537 {
2538 xassert (s->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH);
2539 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2540
2541 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR
2542 && !x_stretch_cursor_p)
2543 {
2544 /* If `x-stretch-block-cursor' is nil, don't draw a block cursor
2545 as wide as the stretch glyph. */
2546 int width = min (FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (s->f), s->background_width);
2547
2548 /* Draw cursor. */
2549 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, s->x, s->y, width, s->height);
2550
2551 /* Clear rest using the GC of the original non-cursor face. */
2552 if (width < s->background_width)
2553 {
2554 int x = s->x + width, y = s->y;
2555 int w = s->background_width - width, h = s->height;
2556 XRectangle r;
2557 GC gc;
2558
2559 if (s->row->mouse_face_p
2560 && cursor_in_mouse_face_p (s->w))
2561 {
2562 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
2563 gc = s->gc;
2564 }
2565 else
2566 gc = s->face->gc;
2567
2568 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2569 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
2570
2571 if (s->face->stipple)
2572 {
2573 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2574 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2575 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2576 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillSolid);
2577 }
2578 else
2579 {
2580 XGCValues xgcv;
2581 XGetGCValues (s->display, gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
2582 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.background);
2583 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2584 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.foreground);
2585 }
2586 }
2587 }
2588 else if (!s->background_filled_p)
2589 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, s->x, s->y, s->background_width,
2590 s->height);
2591
2592 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2593 }
2594
2595
2596 /* Draw glyph string S. */
2597
2598 static void
2599 x_draw_glyph_string (s)
2600 struct glyph_string *s;
2601 {
2602 int relief_drawn_p = 0;
2603
2604 /* If S draws into the background of its successor, draw the
2605 background of the successor first so that S can draw into it.
2606 This makes S->next use XDrawString instead of XDrawImageString. */
2607 if (s->next && s->right_overhang && !s->for_overlaps_p)
2608 {
2609 xassert (s->next->img == NULL);
2610 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s->next);
2611 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s->next);
2612 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s->next, 1);
2613 }
2614
2615 /* Set up S->gc, set clipping and draw S. */
2616 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s);
2617
2618 /* Draw relief (if any) in advance for char/composition so that the
2619 glyph string can be drawn over it. */
2620 if (!s->for_overlaps_p
2621 && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2622 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
2623 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
2624
2625 {
2626 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2627 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2628 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2629 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2630 relief_drawn_p = 1;
2631 }
2632 else
2633 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2634
2635 switch (s->first_glyph->type)
2636 {
2637 case IMAGE_GLYPH:
2638 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s);
2639 break;
2640
2641 case STRETCH_GLYPH:
2642 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s);
2643 break;
2644
2645 case CHAR_GLYPH:
2646 if (s->for_overlaps_p)
2647 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2648 else
2649 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 0);
2650 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2651 break;
2652
2653 case COMPOSITE_GLYPH:
2654 if (s->for_overlaps_p || s->gidx > 0)
2655 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2656 else
2657 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2658 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2659 break;
2660
2661 default:
2662 abort ();
2663 }
2664
2665 if (!s->for_overlaps_p)
2666 {
2667 /* Draw underline. */
2668 if (s->face->underline_p)
2669 {
2670 unsigned long tem, h;
2671 int y;
2672
2673 /* Get the underline thickness. Default is 1 pixel. */
2674 if (!XGetFontProperty (s->font, XA_UNDERLINE_THICKNESS, &h))
2675 h = 1;
2676
2677 /* Get the underline position. This is the recommended
2678 vertical offset in pixels from the baseline to the top of
2679 the underline. This is a signed value according to the
2680 specs, and its default is
2681
2682 ROUND ((maximum descent) / 2), with
2683 ROUND(x) = floor (x + 0.5) */
2684
2685 if (x_use_underline_position_properties
2686 && XGetFontProperty (s->font, XA_UNDERLINE_POSITION, &tem))
2687 y = s->ybase + (long) tem;
2688 else if (s->face->font)
2689 y = s->ybase + (s->face->font->max_bounds.descent + 1) / 2;
2690 else
2691 y = s->y + s->height - h;
2692
2693 if (s->face->underline_defaulted_p)
2694 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2695 s->x, y, s->width, h);
2696 else
2697 {
2698 XGCValues xgcv;
2699 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2700 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->underline_color);
2701 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2702 s->x, y, s->width, h);
2703 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2704 }
2705 }
2706
2707 /* Draw overline. */
2708 if (s->face->overline_p)
2709 {
2710 unsigned long dy = 0, h = 1;
2711
2712 if (s->face->overline_color_defaulted_p)
2713 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2714 s->width, h);
2715 else
2716 {
2717 XGCValues xgcv;
2718 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2719 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->overline_color);
2720 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2721 s->width, h);
2722 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2723 }
2724 }
2725
2726 /* Draw strike-through. */
2727 if (s->face->strike_through_p)
2728 {
2729 unsigned long h = 1;
2730 unsigned long dy = (s->height - h) / 2;
2731
2732 if (s->face->strike_through_color_defaulted_p)
2733 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2734 s->width, h);
2735 else
2736 {
2737 XGCValues xgcv;
2738 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2739 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->strike_through_color);
2740 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2741 s->width, h);
2742 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2743 }
2744 }
2745
2746 /* Draw relief if not yet drawn. */
2747 if (!relief_drawn_p && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
2748 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2749 }
2750
2751 /* Reset clipping. */
2752 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2753 }
2754
2755 /* Shift display to make room for inserted glyphs. */
2756
2757 void
2758 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert (f, x, y, width, height, shift_by)
2759 struct frame *f;
2760 int x, y, width, height, shift_by;
2761 {
2762 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
2763 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
2764 x, y, width, height,
2765 x + shift_by, y);
2766 }
2767
2768 /* Delete N glyphs at the nominal cursor position. Not implemented
2769 for X frames. */
2770
2771 static void
2772 x_delete_glyphs (n)
2773 register int n;
2774 {
2775 abort ();
2776 }
2777
2778
2779 /* Like XClearArea, but check that WIDTH and HEIGHT are reasonable.
2780 If they are <= 0, this is probably an error. */
2781
2782 void
2783 x_clear_area (dpy, window, x, y, width, height, exposures)
2784 Display *dpy;
2785 Window window;
2786 int x, y;
2787 int width, height;
2788 int exposures;
2789 {
2790 xassert (width > 0 && height > 0);
2791 XClearArea (dpy, window, x, y, width, height, exposures);
2792 }
2793
2794
2795 /* Clear entire frame. If updating_frame is non-null, clear that
2796 frame. Otherwise clear the selected frame. */
2797
2798 static void
2799 x_clear_frame ()
2800 {
2801 struct frame *f;
2802
2803 if (updating_frame)
2804 f = updating_frame;
2805 else
2806 f = SELECTED_FRAME ();
2807
2808 /* Clearing the frame will erase any cursor, so mark them all as no
2809 longer visible. */
2810 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f)));
2811 output_cursor.hpos = output_cursor.vpos = 0;
2812 output_cursor.x = -1;
2813
2814 /* We don't set the output cursor here because there will always
2815 follow an explicit cursor_to. */
2816 BLOCK_INPUT;
2817 XClearWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
2818
2819 /* We have to clear the scroll bars, too. If we have changed
2820 colors or something like that, then they should be notified. */
2821 x_scroll_bar_clear (f);
2822
2823 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
2824
2825 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
2826 }
2827
2828
2829 \f
2830 /* Invert the middle quarter of the frame for .15 sec. */
2831
2832 /* We use the select system call to do the waiting, so we have to make
2833 sure it's available. If it isn't, we just won't do visual bells. */
2834
2835 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
2836
2837
2838 /* Subtract the `struct timeval' values X and Y, storing the result in
2839 *RESULT. Return 1 if the difference is negative, otherwise 0. */
2840
2841 static int
2842 timeval_subtract (result, x, y)
2843 struct timeval *result, x, y;
2844 {
2845 /* Perform the carry for the later subtraction by updating y. This
2846 is safer because on some systems the tv_sec member is unsigned. */
2847 if (x.tv_usec < y.tv_usec)
2848 {
2849 int nsec = (y.tv_usec - x.tv_usec) / 1000000 + 1;
2850 y.tv_usec -= 1000000 * nsec;
2851 y.tv_sec += nsec;
2852 }
2853
2854 if (x.tv_usec - y.tv_usec > 1000000)
2855 {
2856 int nsec = (y.tv_usec - x.tv_usec) / 1000000;
2857 y.tv_usec += 1000000 * nsec;
2858 y.tv_sec -= nsec;
2859 }
2860
2861 /* Compute the time remaining to wait. tv_usec is certainly
2862 positive. */
2863 result->tv_sec = x.tv_sec - y.tv_sec;
2864 result->tv_usec = x.tv_usec - y.tv_usec;
2865
2866 /* Return indication of whether the result should be considered
2867 negative. */
2868 return x.tv_sec < y.tv_sec;
2869 }
2870
2871 void
2872 XTflash (f)
2873 struct frame *f;
2874 {
2875 BLOCK_INPUT;
2876
2877 {
2878 GC gc;
2879
2880 /* Create a GC that will use the GXxor function to flip foreground
2881 pixels into background pixels. */
2882 {
2883 XGCValues values;
2884
2885 values.function = GXxor;
2886 values.foreground = (f->output_data.x->foreground_pixel
2887 ^ f->output_data.x->background_pixel);
2888
2889 gc = XCreateGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
2890 GCFunction | GCForeground, &values);
2891 }
2892
2893 {
2894 /* Get the height not including a menu bar widget. */
2895 int height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, FRAME_LINES (f));
2896 /* Height of each line to flash. */
2897 int flash_height = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
2898 /* These will be the left and right margins of the rectangles. */
2899 int flash_left = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
2900 int flash_right = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
2901
2902 int width;
2903
2904 /* Don't flash the area between a scroll bar and the frame
2905 edge it is next to. */
2906 switch (FRAME_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TYPE (f))
2907 {
2908 case vertical_scroll_bar_left:
2909 flash_left += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
2910 break;
2911
2912 case vertical_scroll_bar_right:
2913 flash_right -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
2914 break;
2915
2916 default:
2917 break;
2918 }
2919
2920 width = flash_right - flash_left;
2921
2922 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
2923 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
2924 {
2925 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2926 flash_left,
2927 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
2928 + FRAME_TOOL_BAR_LINES (f) * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f)),
2929 width, flash_height);
2930 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2931 flash_left,
2932 (height - flash_height
2933 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
2934 width, flash_height);
2935 }
2936 else
2937 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
2938 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2939 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
2940 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
2941
2942 x_flush (f);
2943
2944 {
2945 struct timeval wakeup;
2946
2947 EMACS_GET_TIME (wakeup);
2948
2949 /* Compute time to wait until, propagating carry from usecs. */
2950 wakeup.tv_usec += 150000;
2951 wakeup.tv_sec += (wakeup.tv_usec / 1000000);
2952 wakeup.tv_usec %= 1000000;
2953
2954 /* Keep waiting until past the time wakeup or any input gets
2955 available. */
2956 while (! detect_input_pending ())
2957 {
2958 struct timeval current;
2959 struct timeval timeout;
2960
2961 EMACS_GET_TIME (current);
2962
2963 /* Break if result would be negative. */
2964 if (timeval_subtract (&current, wakeup, current))
2965 break;
2966
2967 /* How long `select' should wait. */
2968 timeout.tv_sec = 0;
2969 timeout.tv_usec = 10000;
2970
2971 /* Try to wait that long--but we might wake up sooner. */
2972 select (0, NULL, NULL, NULL, &timeout);
2973 }
2974 }
2975
2976 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
2977 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
2978 {
2979 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2980 flash_left,
2981 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
2982 + FRAME_TOOL_BAR_LINES (f) * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f)),
2983 width, flash_height);
2984 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2985 flash_left,
2986 (height - flash_height
2987 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
2988 width, flash_height);
2989 }
2990 else
2991 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
2992 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2993 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
2994 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
2995
2996 XFreeGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc);
2997 x_flush (f);
2998 }
2999 }
3000
3001 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3002 }
3003
3004 #endif /* defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT) */
3005
3006
3007 /* Make audible bell. */
3008
3009 void
3010 XTring_bell ()
3011 {
3012 struct frame *f = SELECTED_FRAME ();
3013
3014 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))
3015 {
3016 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
3017 if (visible_bell)
3018 XTflash (f);
3019 else
3020 #endif
3021 {
3022 BLOCK_INPUT;
3023 XBell (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), 0);
3024 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3025 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3026 }
3027 }
3028 }
3029
3030 \f
3031 /* Specify how many text lines, from the top of the window,
3032 should be affected by insert-lines and delete-lines operations.
3033 This, and those operations, are used only within an update
3034 that is bounded by calls to x_update_begin and x_update_end. */
3035
3036 static void
3037 XTset_terminal_window (n)
3038 register int n;
3039 {
3040 /* This function intentionally left blank. */
3041 }
3042
3043
3044 \f
3045 /***********************************************************************
3046 Line Dance
3047 ***********************************************************************/
3048
3049 /* Perform an insert-lines or delete-lines operation, inserting N
3050 lines or deleting -N lines at vertical position VPOS. */
3051
3052 static void
3053 x_ins_del_lines (vpos, n)
3054 int vpos, n;
3055 {
3056 abort ();
3057 }
3058
3059
3060 /* Scroll part of the display as described by RUN. */
3061
3062 static void
3063 x_scroll_run (w, run)
3064 struct window *w;
3065 struct run *run;
3066 {
3067 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
3068 int x, y, width, height, from_y, to_y, bottom_y;
3069
3070 /* Get frame-relative bounding box of the text display area of W,
3071 without mode lines. Include in this box the left and right
3072 fringe of W. */
3073 window_box (w, -1, &x, &y, &width, &height);
3074
3075 from_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->current_y);
3076 to_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->desired_y);
3077 bottom_y = y + height;
3078
3079 if (to_y < from_y)
3080 {
3081 /* Scrolling up. Make sure we don't copy part of the mode
3082 line at the bottom. */
3083 if (from_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3084 height = bottom_y - from_y;
3085 else
3086 height = run->height;
3087 }
3088 else
3089 {
3090 /* Scolling down. Make sure we don't copy over the mode line.
3091 at the bottom. */
3092 if (to_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3093 height = bottom_y - to_y;
3094 else
3095 height = run->height;
3096 }
3097
3098 BLOCK_INPUT;
3099
3100 /* Cursor off. Will be switched on again in x_update_window_end. */
3101 updated_window = w;
3102 x_clear_cursor (w);
3103
3104 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
3105 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3106 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
3107 x, from_y,
3108 width, height,
3109 x, to_y);
3110
3111 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3112 }
3113
3114
3115 \f
3116 /***********************************************************************
3117 Exposure Events
3118 ***********************************************************************/
3119
3120 \f
3121 static void
3122 frame_highlight (f)
3123 struct frame *f;
3124 {
3125 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3126 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3127 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3128 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3129 BLOCK_INPUT;
3130 XSetWindowBorder (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3131 f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
3132 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3133 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3134 }
3135
3136 static void
3137 frame_unhighlight (f)
3138 struct frame *f;
3139 {
3140 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3141 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3142 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3143 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3144 BLOCK_INPUT;
3145 XSetWindowBorderPixmap (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3146 f->output_data.x->border_tile);
3147 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3148 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3149 }
3150
3151 /* The focus has changed. Update the frames as necessary to reflect
3152 the new situation. Note that we can't change the selected frame
3153 here, because the Lisp code we are interrupting might become confused.
3154 Each event gets marked with the frame in which it occurred, so the
3155 Lisp code can tell when the switch took place by examining the events. */
3156
3157 static void
3158 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, frame)
3159 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3160 struct frame *frame;
3161 {
3162 struct frame *old_focus = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3163
3164 if (frame != dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3165 {
3166 /* Set this before calling other routines, so that they see
3167 the correct value of x_focus_frame. */
3168 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = frame;
3169
3170 if (old_focus && old_focus->auto_lower)
3171 x_lower_frame (old_focus);
3172
3173 #if 0
3174 selected_frame = frame;
3175 XSETFRAME (XWINDOW (selected_frame->selected_window)->frame,
3176 selected_frame);
3177 Fselect_window (selected_frame->selected_window, Qnil);
3178 choose_minibuf_frame ();
3179 #endif /* ! 0 */
3180
3181 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame && dpyinfo->x_focus_frame->auto_raise)
3182 pending_autoraise_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3183 else
3184 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
3185 }
3186
3187 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo);
3188 }
3189
3190 /* Handle FocusIn and FocusOut state changes for FRAME.
3191 If FRAME has focus and there exists more than one frame, puts
3192 a FOCUS_IN_EVENT into *BUFP. */
3193
3194 static void
3195 x_focus_changed (type, state, dpyinfo, frame, bufp)
3196 int type;
3197 int state;
3198 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3199 struct frame *frame;
3200 struct input_event *bufp;
3201 {
3202 if (type == FocusIn)
3203 {
3204 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame != frame)
3205 {
3206 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, frame);
3207 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = frame;
3208
3209 /* Don't stop displaying the initial startup message
3210 for a switch-frame event we don't need. */
3211 if (GC_NILP (Vterminal_frame)
3212 && GC_CONSP (Vframe_list)
3213 && !GC_NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
3214 {
3215 bufp->kind = FOCUS_IN_EVENT;
3216 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, frame);
3217 }
3218 }
3219
3220 frame->output_data.x->focus_state |= state;
3221
3222 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3223 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3224 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3225 #endif
3226 }
3227 else if (type == FocusOut)
3228 {
3229 frame->output_data.x->focus_state &= ~state;
3230
3231 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame == frame)
3232 {
3233 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
3234 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
3235 }
3236
3237 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3238 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3239 XUnsetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3240 #endif
3241 }
3242 }
3243
3244 /* The focus may have changed. Figure out if it is a real focus change,
3245 by checking both FocusIn/Out and Enter/LeaveNotify events.
3246
3247 Returns FOCUS_IN_EVENT event in *BUFP. */
3248
3249 static void
3250 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, event, bufp)
3251 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3252 XEvent *event;
3253 struct input_event *bufp;
3254 {
3255 struct frame *frame;
3256
3257 frame = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xany.window);
3258 if (! frame)
3259 return;
3260
3261 switch (event->type)
3262 {
3263 case EnterNotify:
3264 case LeaveNotify:
3265 {
3266 struct frame *focus_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame;
3267 int focus_state
3268 = focus_frame ? focus_frame->output_data.x->focus_state : 0;
3269
3270 if (event->xcrossing.detail != NotifyInferior
3271 && event->xcrossing.focus
3272 && ! (focus_state & FOCUS_EXPLICIT))
3273 x_focus_changed ((event->type == EnterNotify ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3274 FOCUS_IMPLICIT,
3275 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3276 }
3277 break;
3278
3279 case FocusIn:
3280 case FocusOut:
3281 x_focus_changed (event->type,
3282 (event->xfocus.detail == NotifyPointer ?
3283 FOCUS_IMPLICIT : FOCUS_EXPLICIT),
3284 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3285 break;
3286 }
3287 }
3288
3289
3290 /* Handle an event saying the mouse has moved out of an Emacs frame. */
3291
3292 void
3293 x_mouse_leave (dpyinfo)
3294 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3295 {
3296 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame);
3297 }
3298
3299 /* The focus has changed, or we have redirected a frame's focus to
3300 another frame (this happens when a frame uses a surrogate
3301 mini-buffer frame). Shift the highlight as appropriate.
3302
3303 The FRAME argument doesn't necessarily have anything to do with which
3304 frame is being highlighted or un-highlighted; we only use it to find
3305 the appropriate X display info. */
3306
3307 static void
3308 XTframe_rehighlight (frame)
3309 struct frame *frame;
3310 {
3311 x_frame_rehighlight (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (frame));
3312 }
3313
3314 static void
3315 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo)
3316 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3317 {
3318 struct frame *old_highlight = dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame;
3319
3320 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3321 {
3322 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame
3323 = ((GC_FRAMEP (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)))
3324 ? XFRAME (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame))
3325 : dpyinfo->x_focus_frame);
3326 if (! FRAME_LIVE_P (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame))
3327 {
3328 FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame) = Qnil;
3329 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3330 }
3331 }
3332 else
3333 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
3334
3335 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame != old_highlight)
3336 {
3337 if (old_highlight)
3338 frame_unhighlight (old_highlight);
3339 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
3340 frame_highlight (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame);
3341 }
3342 }
3343
3344
3345 \f
3346 /* Keyboard processing - modifier keys, vendor-specific keysyms, etc. */
3347
3348 /* Initialize mode_switch_bit and modifier_meaning. */
3349 static void
3350 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo)
3351 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3352 {
3353 int min_code, max_code;
3354 KeySym *syms;
3355 int syms_per_code;
3356 XModifierKeymap *mods;
3357
3358 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = 0;
3359 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = 0;
3360 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3361 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask = 0;
3362 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask = 0;
3363
3364 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
3365 XDisplayKeycodes (dpyinfo->display, &min_code, &max_code);
3366 #else
3367 min_code = dpyinfo->display->min_keycode;
3368 max_code = dpyinfo->display->max_keycode;
3369 #endif
3370
3371 syms = XGetKeyboardMapping (dpyinfo->display,
3372 min_code, max_code - min_code + 1,
3373 &syms_per_code);
3374 mods = XGetModifierMapping (dpyinfo->display);
3375
3376 /* Scan the modifier table to see which modifier bits the Meta and
3377 Alt keysyms are on. */
3378 {
3379 int row, col; /* The row and column in the modifier table. */
3380 int found_alt_or_meta;
3381
3382 for (row = 3; row < 8; row++)
3383 {
3384 found_alt_or_meta = 0;
3385 for (col = 0; col < mods->max_keypermod; col++)
3386 {
3387 KeyCode code = mods->modifiermap[(row * mods->max_keypermod) + col];
3388
3389 /* Zeroes are used for filler. Skip them. */
3390 if (code == 0)
3391 continue;
3392
3393 /* Are any of this keycode's keysyms a meta key? */
3394 {
3395 int code_col;
3396
3397 for (code_col = 0; code_col < syms_per_code; code_col++)
3398 {
3399 int sym = syms[((code - min_code) * syms_per_code) + code_col];
3400
3401 switch (sym)
3402 {
3403 case XK_Meta_L:
3404 case XK_Meta_R:
3405 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3406 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3407 break;
3408
3409 case XK_Alt_L:
3410 case XK_Alt_R:
3411 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3412 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3413 break;
3414
3415 case XK_Hyper_L:
3416 case XK_Hyper_R:
3417 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3418 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3419 code_col = syms_per_code;
3420 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3421 break;
3422
3423 case XK_Super_L:
3424 case XK_Super_R:
3425 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3426 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3427 code_col = syms_per_code;
3428 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3429 break;
3430
3431 case XK_Shift_Lock:
3432 /* Ignore this if it's not on the lock modifier. */
3433 if (!found_alt_or_meta && ((1 << row) == LockMask))
3434 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = LockMask;
3435 code_col = syms_per_code;
3436 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3437 break;
3438 }
3439 }
3440 }
3441 }
3442 }
3443 }
3444
3445 /* If we couldn't find any meta keys, accept any alt keys as meta keys. */
3446 if (! dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3447 {
3448 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask;
3449 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3450 }
3451
3452 /* If some keys are both alt and meta,
3453 make them just meta, not alt. */
3454 if (dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3455 {
3456 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask &= ~dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask;
3457 }
3458
3459 XFree ((char *) syms);
3460 XFreeModifiermap (mods);
3461 }
3462
3463 /* Convert between the modifier bits X uses and the modifier bits
3464 Emacs uses. */
3465
3466 static unsigned int
3467 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo, state)
3468 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3469 unsigned int state;
3470 {
3471 EMACS_UINT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3472 EMACS_UINT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3473 EMACS_UINT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3474 EMACS_UINT mod_super = super_modifier;
3475 Lisp_Object tem;
3476
3477 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3478 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_alt = XUINT (tem);
3479 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3480 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_meta = XUINT (tem);
3481 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3482 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_hyper = XUINT (tem);
3483 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3484 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_super = XUINT (tem);
3485
3486
3487 return ( ((state & (ShiftMask | dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask)) ? shift_modifier : 0)
3488 | ((state & ControlMask) ? ctrl_modifier : 0)
3489 | ((state & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask) ? mod_meta : 0)
3490 | ((state & dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask) ? mod_alt : 0)
3491 | ((state & dpyinfo->super_mod_mask) ? mod_super : 0)
3492 | ((state & dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask) ? mod_hyper : 0));
3493 }
3494
3495 static unsigned int
3496 x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (dpyinfo, state)
3497 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3498 unsigned int state;
3499 {
3500 EMACS_UINT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3501 EMACS_UINT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3502 EMACS_UINT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3503 EMACS_UINT mod_super = super_modifier;
3504
3505 Lisp_Object tem;
3506
3507 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3508 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_alt = XUINT (tem);
3509 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3510 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_meta = XUINT (tem);
3511 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3512 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_hyper = XUINT (tem);
3513 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3514 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_super = XUINT (tem);
3515
3516
3517 return ( ((state & mod_alt) ? dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask : 0)
3518 | ((state & mod_super) ? dpyinfo->super_mod_mask : 0)
3519 | ((state & mod_hyper) ? dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask : 0)
3520 | ((state & shift_modifier) ? ShiftMask : 0)
3521 | ((state & ctrl_modifier) ? ControlMask : 0)
3522 | ((state & mod_meta) ? dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask : 0));
3523 }
3524
3525 /* Convert a keysym to its name. */
3526
3527 char *
3528 x_get_keysym_name (keysym)
3529 KeySym keysym;
3530 {
3531 char *value;
3532
3533 BLOCK_INPUT;
3534 value = XKeysymToString (keysym);
3535 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3536
3537 return value;
3538 }
3539
3540
3541 \f
3542 /* Mouse clicks and mouse movement. Rah. */
3543
3544 /* Prepare a mouse-event in *RESULT for placement in the input queue.
3545
3546 If the event is a button press, then note that we have grabbed
3547 the mouse. */
3548
3549 static Lisp_Object
3550 construct_mouse_click (result, event, f)
3551 struct input_event *result;
3552 XButtonEvent *event;
3553 struct frame *f;
3554 {
3555 /* Make the event type NO_EVENT; we'll change that when we decide
3556 otherwise. */
3557 result->kind = MOUSE_CLICK_EVENT;
3558 result->code = event->button - Button1;
3559 result->timestamp = event->time;
3560 result->modifiers = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
3561 event->state)
3562 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
3563 ? up_modifier
3564 : down_modifier));
3565
3566 XSETINT (result->x, event->x);
3567 XSETINT (result->y, event->y);
3568 XSETFRAME (result->frame_or_window, f);
3569 result->arg = Qnil;
3570 return Qnil;
3571 }
3572
3573 \f
3574 /* Function to report a mouse movement to the mainstream Emacs code.
3575 The input handler calls this.
3576
3577 We have received a mouse movement event, which is given in *event.
3578 If the mouse is over a different glyph than it was last time, tell
3579 the mainstream emacs code by setting mouse_moved. If not, ask for
3580 another motion event, so we can check again the next time it moves. */
3581
3582 static XMotionEvent last_mouse_motion_event;
3583 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_motion_frame;
3584
3585 static void
3586 note_mouse_movement (frame, event)
3587 FRAME_PTR frame;
3588 XMotionEvent *event;
3589 {
3590 last_mouse_movement_time = event->time;
3591 last_mouse_motion_event = *event;
3592 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame, frame);
3593
3594 if (event->window != FRAME_X_WINDOW (frame))
3595 {
3596 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3597 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3598 note_mouse_highlight (frame, -1, -1);
3599 }
3600
3601 /* Has the mouse moved off the glyph it was on at the last sighting? */
3602 else if (event->x < last_mouse_glyph.x
3603 || event->x >= last_mouse_glyph.x + last_mouse_glyph.width
3604 || event->y < last_mouse_glyph.y
3605 || event->y >= last_mouse_glyph.y + last_mouse_glyph.height)
3606 {
3607 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3608 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3609 note_mouse_highlight (frame, event->x, event->y);
3610 }
3611 }
3612
3613 \f
3614 /************************************************************************
3615 Mouse Face
3616 ************************************************************************/
3617
3618 static void
3619 redo_mouse_highlight ()
3620 {
3621 if (!NILP (last_mouse_motion_frame)
3622 && FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame)))
3623 note_mouse_highlight (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame),
3624 last_mouse_motion_event.x,
3625 last_mouse_motion_event.y);
3626 }
3627
3628
3629 static int glyph_rect P_ ((struct frame *f, int, int, XRectangle *));
3630
3631
3632 /* Try to determine frame pixel position and size of the glyph under
3633 frame pixel coordinates X/Y on frame F . Return the position and
3634 size in *RECT. Value is non-zero if we could compute these
3635 values. */
3636
3637 static int
3638 glyph_rect (f, x, y, rect)
3639 struct frame *f;
3640 int x, y;
3641 XRectangle *rect;
3642 {
3643 Lisp_Object window;
3644 struct window *w;
3645 struct glyph_row *r, *end_row;
3646
3647 window = window_from_coordinates (f, x, y, 0, &x, &y, 0);
3648 if (NILP (window))
3649 return 0;
3650
3651 w = XWINDOW (window);
3652 r = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
3653 end_row = r + w->current_matrix->nrows - 1;
3654
3655 for (; r < end_row && r->enabled_p; ++r)
3656 {
3657 if (r->y >= y)
3658 {
3659 struct glyph *g = r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
3660 struct glyph *end = g + r->used[TEXT_AREA];
3661 int gx = r->x;
3662 while (g < end && gx < x)
3663 gx += g->pixel_width, ++g;
3664 if (g < end)
3665 {
3666 rect->width = g->pixel_width;
3667 rect->height = r->height;
3668 rect->x = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, gx);
3669 rect->y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, r->y);
3670 return 1;
3671 }
3672 break;
3673 }
3674 }
3675
3676 return 0;
3677 }
3678
3679
3680 /* Return the current position of the mouse.
3681 *FP should be a frame which indicates which display to ask about.
3682
3683 If the mouse movement started in a scroll bar, set *FP, *BAR_WINDOW,
3684 and *PART to the frame, window, and scroll bar part that the mouse
3685 is over. Set *X and *Y to the portion and whole of the mouse's
3686 position on the scroll bar.
3687
3688 If the mouse movement started elsewhere, set *FP to the frame the
3689 mouse is on, *BAR_WINDOW to nil, and *X and *Y to the character cell
3690 the mouse is over.
3691
3692 Set *TIME to the server time-stamp for the time at which the mouse
3693 was at this position.
3694
3695 Don't store anything if we don't have a valid set of values to report.
3696
3697 This clears the mouse_moved flag, so we can wait for the next mouse
3698 movement. */
3699
3700 static void
3701 XTmouse_position (fp, insist, bar_window, part, x, y, time)
3702 FRAME_PTR *fp;
3703 int insist;
3704 Lisp_Object *bar_window;
3705 enum scroll_bar_part *part;
3706 Lisp_Object *x, *y;
3707 unsigned long *time;
3708 {
3709 FRAME_PTR f1;
3710
3711 BLOCK_INPUT;
3712
3713 if (! NILP (last_mouse_scroll_bar) && insist == 0)
3714 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, time);
3715 else
3716 {
3717 Window root;
3718 int root_x, root_y;
3719
3720 Window dummy_window;
3721 int dummy;
3722
3723 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
3724
3725 /* Clear the mouse-moved flag for every frame on this display. */
3726 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
3727 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp))
3728 XFRAME (frame)->mouse_moved = 0;
3729
3730 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3731
3732 /* Figure out which root window we're on. */
3733 XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3734 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)),
3735
3736 /* The root window which contains the pointer. */
3737 &root,
3738
3739 /* Trash which we can't trust if the pointer is on
3740 a different screen. */
3741 &dummy_window,
3742
3743 /* The position on that root window. */
3744 &root_x, &root_y,
3745
3746 /* More trash we can't trust. */
3747 &dummy, &dummy,
3748
3749 /* Modifier keys and pointer buttons, about which
3750 we don't care. */
3751 (unsigned int *) &dummy);
3752
3753 /* Now we have a position on the root; find the innermost window
3754 containing the pointer. */
3755 {
3756 Window win, child;
3757 int win_x, win_y;
3758 int parent_x = 0, parent_y = 0;
3759 int count;
3760
3761 win = root;
3762
3763 /* XTranslateCoordinates can get errors if the window
3764 structure is changing at the same time this function
3765 is running. So at least we must not crash from them. */
3766
3767 count = x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp));
3768
3769 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp)->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
3770 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
3771 {
3772 /* If mouse was grabbed on a frame, give coords for that frame
3773 even if the mouse is now outside it. */
3774 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3775
3776 /* From-window, to-window. */
3777 root, FRAME_X_WINDOW (last_mouse_frame),
3778
3779 /* From-position, to-position. */
3780 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3781
3782 /* Child of win. */
3783 &child);
3784 f1 = last_mouse_frame;
3785 }
3786 else
3787 {
3788 while (1)
3789 {
3790 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3791
3792 /* From-window, to-window. */
3793 root, win,
3794
3795 /* From-position, to-position. */
3796 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3797
3798 /* Child of win. */
3799 &child);
3800
3801 if (child == None || child == win)
3802 break;
3803
3804 win = child;
3805 parent_x = win_x;
3806 parent_y = win_y;
3807 }
3808
3809 /* Now we know that:
3810 win is the innermost window containing the pointer
3811 (XTC says it has no child containing the pointer),
3812 win_x and win_y are the pointer's position in it
3813 (XTC did this the last time through), and
3814 parent_x and parent_y are the pointer's position in win's parent.
3815 (They are what win_x and win_y were when win was child.
3816 If win is the root window, it has no parent, and
3817 parent_{x,y} are invalid, but that's okay, because we'll
3818 never use them in that case.) */
3819
3820 /* Is win one of our frames? */
3821 f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
3822
3823 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
3824 /* If we end up with the menu bar window, say it's not
3825 on the frame. */
3826 if (f1 != NULL
3827 && f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget
3828 && win == XtWindow (f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget))
3829 f1 = NULL;
3830 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
3831 }
3832
3833 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)))
3834 f1 = 0;
3835
3836 x_uncatch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp), count);
3837
3838 /* If not, is it one of our scroll bars? */
3839 if (! f1)
3840 {
3841 struct scroll_bar *bar;
3842
3843 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp), win);
3844
3845 if (bar)
3846 {
3847 f1 = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
3848 win_x = parent_x;
3849 win_y = parent_y;
3850 }
3851 }
3852
3853 if (f1 == 0 && insist > 0)
3854 f1 = SELECTED_FRAME ();
3855
3856 if (f1)
3857 {
3858 /* Ok, we found a frame. Store all the values.
3859 last_mouse_glyph is a rectangle used to reduce the
3860 generation of mouse events. To not miss any motion
3861 events, we must divide the frame into rectangles of the
3862 size of the smallest character that could be displayed
3863 on it, i.e. into the same rectangles that matrices on
3864 the frame are divided into. */
3865
3866 int width, height, gx, gy;
3867 XRectangle rect;
3868
3869 if (glyph_rect (f1, win_x, win_y, &rect))
3870 last_mouse_glyph = rect;
3871 else
3872 {
3873 width = FRAME_SMALLEST_CHAR_WIDTH (f1);
3874 height = FRAME_SMALLEST_FONT_HEIGHT (f1);
3875 gx = win_x;
3876 gy = win_y;
3877
3878 /* Arrange for the division in FRAME_PIXEL_X_TO_COL etc. to
3879 round down even for negative values. */
3880 if (gx < 0)
3881 gx -= width - 1;
3882 if (gy < 0)
3883 gy -= height - 1;
3884 gx = (gx + width - 1) / width * width;
3885 gy = (gy + height - 1) / height * height;
3886
3887 last_mouse_glyph.width = width;
3888 last_mouse_glyph.height = height;
3889 last_mouse_glyph.x = gx;
3890 last_mouse_glyph.y = gy;
3891 }
3892
3893 *bar_window = Qnil;
3894 *part = 0;
3895 *fp = f1;
3896 XSETINT (*x, win_x);
3897 XSETINT (*y, win_y);
3898 *time = last_mouse_movement_time;
3899 }
3900 }
3901 }
3902
3903 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3904 }
3905
3906
3907 \f
3908 /***********************************************************************
3909 Scroll bars
3910 ***********************************************************************/
3911
3912 /* Scroll bar support. */
3913
3914 /* Given an X window ID and a DISPLAY, find the struct scroll_bar which
3915 manages it.
3916 This can be called in GC, so we have to make sure to strip off mark
3917 bits. */
3918
3919 static struct scroll_bar *
3920 x_window_to_scroll_bar (display, window_id)
3921 Display *display;
3922 Window window_id;
3923 {
3924 Lisp_Object tail;
3925
3926 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
3927 window_id = (Window) xg_get_scroll_id_for_window (display, window_id);
3928 #endif /* USE_GTK && USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
3929
3930 for (tail = Vframe_list;
3931 XGCTYPE (tail) == Lisp_Cons;
3932 tail = XCDR (tail))
3933 {
3934 Lisp_Object frame, bar, condemned;
3935
3936 frame = XCAR (tail);
3937 /* All elements of Vframe_list should be frames. */
3938 if (! GC_FRAMEP (frame))
3939 abort ();
3940
3941 /* Scan this frame's scroll bar list for a scroll bar with the
3942 right window ID. */
3943 condemned = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
3944 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
3945 /* This trick allows us to search both the ordinary and
3946 condemned scroll bar lists with one loop. */
3947 ! GC_NILP (bar) || (bar = condemned,
3948 condemned = Qnil,
3949 ! GC_NILP (bar));
3950 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
3951 if (SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (XSCROLL_BAR (bar)) == window_id &&
3952 FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == display)
3953 return XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
3954 }
3955
3956 return 0;
3957 }
3958
3959
3960 #if defined USE_LUCID
3961
3962 /* Return the Lucid menu bar WINDOW is part of. Return null
3963 if WINDOW is not part of a menu bar. */
3964
3965 static Widget
3966 x_window_to_menu_bar (window)
3967 Window window;
3968 {
3969 Lisp_Object tail;
3970
3971 for (tail = Vframe_list;
3972 XGCTYPE (tail) == Lisp_Cons;
3973 tail = XCDR (tail))
3974 {
3975 Lisp_Object frame = XCAR (tail);
3976 Widget menu_bar = XFRAME (frame)->output_data.x->menubar_widget;
3977
3978 if (menu_bar && xlwmenu_window_p (menu_bar, window))
3979 return menu_bar;
3980 }
3981
3982 return NULL;
3983 }
3984
3985 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
3986
3987 \f
3988 /************************************************************************
3989 Toolkit scroll bars
3990 ************************************************************************/
3991
3992 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
3993
3994 static void x_scroll_bar_to_input_event P_ ((XEvent *, struct input_event *));
3995 static void x_send_scroll_bar_event P_ ((Lisp_Object, int, int, int));
3996 static void x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar P_ ((struct frame *,
3997 struct scroll_bar *));
3998 static void x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb P_ ((struct scroll_bar *,
3999 int, int, int));
4000
4001
4002 /* Lisp window being scrolled. Set when starting to interact with
4003 a toolkit scroll bar, reset to nil when ending the interaction. */
4004
4005 static Lisp_Object window_being_scrolled;
4006
4007 /* Last scroll bar part sent in xm_scroll_callback. */
4008
4009 static int last_scroll_bar_part;
4010
4011 /* Whether this is an Xaw with arrow-scrollbars. This should imply
4012 that movements of 1/20 of the screen size are mapped to up/down. */
4013
4014 #ifndef USE_GTK
4015 /* Id of action hook installed for scroll bars. */
4016
4017 static XtActionHookId action_hook_id;
4018
4019 static Boolean xaw3d_arrow_scroll;
4020
4021 /* Whether the drag scrolling maintains the mouse at the top of the
4022 thumb. If not, resizing the thumb needs to be done more carefully
4023 to avoid jerkyness. */
4024
4025 static Boolean xaw3d_pick_top;
4026
4027 extern void set_vertical_scroll_bar P_ ((struct window *));
4028
4029 /* Action hook installed via XtAppAddActionHook when toolkit scroll
4030 bars are used.. The hook is responsible for detecting when
4031 the user ends an interaction with the scroll bar, and generates
4032 a `end-scroll' SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT' event if so. */
4033
4034 static void
4035 xt_action_hook (widget, client_data, action_name, event, params,
4036 num_params)
4037 Widget widget;
4038 XtPointer client_data;
4039 String action_name;
4040 XEvent *event;
4041 String *params;
4042 Cardinal *num_params;
4043 {
4044 int scroll_bar_p;
4045 char *end_action;
4046
4047 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4048 scroll_bar_p = XmIsScrollBar (widget);
4049 end_action = "Release";
4050 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4051 scroll_bar_p = XtIsSubclass (widget, scrollbarWidgetClass);
4052 end_action = "EndScroll";
4053 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
4054
4055 if (scroll_bar_p
4056 && strcmp (action_name, end_action) == 0
4057 && WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
4058 {
4059 struct window *w;
4060
4061 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
4062 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
4063 w = XWINDOW (window_being_scrolled);
4064
4065 if (!NILP (XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging))
4066 {
4067 XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging = Qnil;
4068 /* The thumb size is incorrect while dragging: fix it. */
4069 set_vertical_scroll_bar (w);
4070 }
4071 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4072 last_scroll_bar_part = -1;
4073
4074 /* Xt timeouts no longer needed. */
4075 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 0;
4076 }
4077 }
4078 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4079
4080 /* A vector of windows used for communication between
4081 x_send_scroll_bar_event and x_scroll_bar_to_input_event. */
4082
4083 static struct window **scroll_bar_windows;
4084 static int scroll_bar_windows_size;
4085
4086
4087 /* Send a client message with message type Xatom_Scrollbar for a
4088 scroll action to the frame of WINDOW. PART is a value identifying
4089 the part of the scroll bar that was clicked on. PORTION is the
4090 amount to scroll of a whole of WHOLE. */
4091
4092 static void
4093 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window, part, portion, whole)
4094 Lisp_Object window;
4095 int part, portion, whole;
4096 {
4097 XEvent event;
4098 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) &event;
4099 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
4100 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4101 int i;
4102
4103 BLOCK_INPUT;
4104
4105 /* Construct a ClientMessage event to send to the frame. */
4106 ev->type = ClientMessage;
4107 ev->message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_Scrollbar;
4108 ev->display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
4109 ev->window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
4110 ev->format = 32;
4111
4112 /* We can only transfer 32 bits in the XClientMessageEvent, which is
4113 not enough to store a pointer or Lisp_Object on a 64 bit system.
4114 So, store the window in scroll_bar_windows and pass the index
4115 into that array in the event. */
4116 for (i = 0; i < scroll_bar_windows_size; ++i)
4117 if (scroll_bar_windows[i] == NULL)
4118 break;
4119
4120 if (i == scroll_bar_windows_size)
4121 {
4122 int new_size = max (10, 2 * scroll_bar_windows_size);
4123 size_t nbytes = new_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4124 size_t old_nbytes = scroll_bar_windows_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4125
4126 scroll_bar_windows = (struct window **) xrealloc (scroll_bar_windows,
4127 nbytes);
4128 bzero (&scroll_bar_windows[i], nbytes - old_nbytes);
4129 scroll_bar_windows_size = new_size;
4130 }
4131
4132 scroll_bar_windows[i] = w;
4133 ev->data.l[0] = (long) i;
4134 ev->data.l[1] = (long) part;
4135 ev->data.l[2] = (long) 0;
4136 ev->data.l[3] = (long) portion;
4137 ev->data.l[4] = (long) whole;
4138
4139 /* Make Xt timeouts work while the scroll bar is active. */
4140 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 1;
4141
4142 /* Setting the event mask to zero means that the message will
4143 be sent to the client that created the window, and if that
4144 window no longer exists, no event will be sent. */
4145 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), False, 0, &event);
4146 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4147 }
4148
4149
4150 /* Transform a scroll bar ClientMessage EVENT to an Emacs input event
4151 in *IEVENT. */
4152
4153 static void
4154 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (event, ievent)
4155 XEvent *event;
4156 struct input_event *ievent;
4157 {
4158 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) event;
4159 Lisp_Object window;
4160 struct frame *f;
4161 struct window *w;
4162
4163 w = scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]];
4164 scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]] = NULL;
4165
4166 XSETWINDOW (window, w);
4167 f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4168
4169 ievent->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
4170 ievent->frame_or_window = window;
4171 ievent->arg = Qnil;
4172 #ifdef USE_GTK
4173 ievent->timestamp = CurrentTime;
4174 #else
4175 ievent->timestamp = XtLastTimestampProcessed (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
4176 #endif
4177 ievent->part = ev->data.l[1];
4178 ievent->code = ev->data.l[2];
4179 ievent->x = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[3]);
4180 ievent->y = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[4]);
4181 ievent->modifiers = 0;
4182 }
4183
4184
4185 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4186
4187 /* Minimum and maximum values used for Motif scroll bars. */
4188
4189 #define XM_SB_MAX 10000000
4190
4191
4192 /* Scroll bar callback for Motif scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4193 bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure.
4194 CALL_DATA is a pointer to a XmScrollBarCallbackStruct. */
4195
4196 static void
4197 xm_scroll_callback (widget, client_data, call_data)
4198 Widget widget;
4199 XtPointer client_data, call_data;
4200 {
4201 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4202 XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *cs = (XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *) call_data;
4203 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4204
4205 switch (cs->reason)
4206 {
4207 case XmCR_DECREMENT:
4208 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4209 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4210 break;
4211
4212 case XmCR_INCREMENT:
4213 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4214 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4215 break;
4216
4217 case XmCR_PAGE_DECREMENT:
4218 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4219 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4220 break;
4221
4222 case XmCR_PAGE_INCREMENT:
4223 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4224 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4225 break;
4226
4227 case XmCR_TO_TOP:
4228 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4229 part = scroll_bar_to_top;
4230 break;
4231
4232 case XmCR_TO_BOTTOM:
4233 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4234 part = scroll_bar_to_bottom;
4235 break;
4236
4237 case XmCR_DRAG:
4238 {
4239 int slider_size;
4240
4241 /* Get the slider size. */
4242 BLOCK_INPUT;
4243 XtVaGetValues (widget, XmNsliderSize, &slider_size, NULL);
4244 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4245
4246 whole = XM_SB_MAX - slider_size;
4247 portion = min (cs->value, whole);
4248 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4249 bar->dragging = make_number (cs->value);
4250 }
4251 break;
4252
4253 case XmCR_VALUE_CHANGED:
4254 break;
4255 };
4256
4257 if (part >= 0)
4258 {
4259 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4260 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4261 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4262 }
4263 }
4264
4265
4266 #else /* !USE_MOTIF, i.e. Xaw or GTK */
4267 #ifdef USE_GTK
4268 /* Scroll bar callback for GTK scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4269 bar widget. DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure. */
4270
4271 static void
4272 xg_scroll_callback (widget, data)
4273 GtkRange *widget;
4274 gpointer data;
4275 {
4276 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) data;
4277 gdouble previous;
4278 gdouble position;
4279 gdouble *p;
4280 int diff;
4281
4282 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4283 GtkAdjustment *adj = GTK_ADJUSTMENT (gtk_range_get_adjustment (widget));
4284
4285 position = gtk_adjustment_get_value (adj);
4286
4287 p = g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (widget), XG_LAST_SB_DATA);
4288 if (! p)
4289 {
4290 p = (gdouble*) xmalloc (sizeof (gdouble));
4291 *p = XG_SB_MIN;
4292 g_object_set_data (G_OBJECT (widget), XG_LAST_SB_DATA, p);
4293 }
4294
4295 previous = *p;
4296 *p = position;
4297
4298 if (xg_ignore_gtk_scrollbar) return;
4299
4300 diff = (int) (position - previous);
4301
4302 if (diff == (int) adj->step_increment)
4303 {
4304 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4305 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4306 }
4307 else if (-diff == (int) adj->step_increment)
4308 {
4309 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4310 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4311 }
4312 else if (diff == (int) adj->page_increment)
4313 {
4314 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4315 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4316 }
4317 else if (-diff == (int) adj->page_increment)
4318 {
4319 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4320 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4321 }
4322 else
4323 {
4324 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4325 whole = adj->upper - adj->page_size;
4326 portion = min ((int)position, whole);
4327 bar->dragging = make_number ((int)portion);
4328 }
4329
4330 if (part >= 0)
4331 {
4332 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4333 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4334 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4335 }
4336 }
4337
4338 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4339
4340 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked when the thumb is dragged.
4341 WIDGET is the scroll bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the
4342 scroll bar struct. CALL_DATA is a pointer to a float saying where
4343 the thumb is. */
4344
4345 static void
4346 xaw_jump_callback (widget, client_data, call_data)
4347 Widget widget;
4348 XtPointer client_data, call_data;
4349 {
4350 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4351 float top = *(float *) call_data;
4352 float shown;
4353 int whole, portion, height;
4354 int part;
4355
4356 /* Get the size of the thumb, a value between 0 and 1. */
4357 BLOCK_INPUT;
4358 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNshown, &shown, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4359 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4360
4361 whole = 10000000;
4362 portion = shown < 1 ? top * whole : 0;
4363
4364 if (shown < 1 && (abs (top + shown - 1) < 1.0/height))
4365 /* Some derivatives of Xaw refuse to shrink the thumb when you reach
4366 the bottom, so we force the scrolling whenever we see that we're
4367 too close to the bottom (in x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb
4368 we try to ensure that we always stay two pixels away from the
4369 bottom). */
4370 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4371 else
4372 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4373
4374 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4375 bar->dragging = make_number (portion);
4376 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4377 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4378 }
4379
4380
4381 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked for incremental scrolling.,
4382 i.e. line or page up or down. WIDGET is the Xaw scroll bar
4383 widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure for
4384 the scroll bar. CALL_DATA is an integer specifying the action that
4385 has taken place. Its magnitude is in the range 0..height of the
4386 scroll bar. Negative values mean scroll towards buffer start.
4387 Values < height of scroll bar mean line-wise movement. */
4388
4389 static void
4390 xaw_scroll_callback (widget, client_data, call_data)
4391 Widget widget;
4392 XtPointer client_data, call_data;
4393 {
4394 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4395 /* The position really is stored cast to a pointer. */
4396 int position = (long) call_data;
4397 Dimension height;
4398 int part;
4399
4400 /* Get the height of the scroll bar. */
4401 BLOCK_INPUT;
4402 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4403 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4404
4405 if (abs (position) >= height)
4406 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_above_handle : scroll_bar_below_handle;
4407
4408 /* If Xaw3d was compiled with ARROW_SCROLLBAR,
4409 it maps line-movement to call_data = max(5, height/20). */
4410 else if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll && abs (position) <= max (5, height / 20))
4411 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_up_arrow : scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4412 else
4413 part = scroll_bar_move_ratio;
4414
4415 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4416 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4417 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4418 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, position, height);
4419 }
4420
4421 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4422 #endif /* not USE_MOTIF */
4423
4424 #define SCROLL_BAR_NAME "verticalScrollBar"
4425
4426 /* Create the widget for scroll bar BAR on frame F. Record the widget
4427 and X window of the scroll bar in BAR. */
4428
4429 #ifdef USE_GTK
4430 static void
4431 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar)
4432 struct frame *f;
4433 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4434 {
4435 char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4436
4437 BLOCK_INPUT;
4438 xg_create_scroll_bar (f, bar, G_CALLBACK (xg_scroll_callback),
4439 scroll_bar_name);
4440 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4441 }
4442
4443 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4444
4445 static void
4446 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar)
4447 struct frame *f;
4448 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4449 {
4450 Window xwindow;
4451 Widget widget;
4452 Arg av[20];
4453 int ac = 0;
4454 char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4455 unsigned long pixel;
4456
4457 BLOCK_INPUT;
4458
4459 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4460 /* Set resources. Create the widget. */
4461 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4462 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNminimum, 0); ++ac;
4463 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNmaximum, XM_SB_MAX); ++ac;
4464 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNorientation, XmVERTICAL); ++ac;
4465 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNprocessingDirection, XmMAX_ON_BOTTOM), ++ac;
4466 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNincrement, 1); ++ac;
4467 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNpageIncrement, 1); ++ac;
4468
4469 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4470 if (pixel != -1)
4471 {
4472 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNforeground, pixel);
4473 ++ac;
4474 }
4475
4476 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4477 if (pixel != -1)
4478 {
4479 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNbackground, pixel);
4480 ++ac;
4481 }
4482
4483 widget = XmCreateScrollBar (f->output_data.x->edit_widget,
4484 scroll_bar_name, av, ac);
4485
4486 /* Add one callback for everything that can happen. */
4487 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4488 (XtPointer) bar);
4489 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdragCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4490 (XtPointer) bar);
4491 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNincrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4492 (XtPointer) bar);
4493 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageDecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4494 (XtPointer) bar);
4495 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageIncrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4496 (XtPointer) bar);
4497 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoBottomCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4498 (XtPointer) bar);
4499 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoTopCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4500 (XtPointer) bar);
4501
4502 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4503 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4504
4505 /* Set the cursor to an arrow. I didn't find a resource to do that.
4506 And I'm wondering why it hasn't an arrow cursor by default. */
4507 XDefineCursor (XtDisplay (widget), XtWindow (widget),
4508 f->output_data.x->nontext_cursor);
4509
4510 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4511
4512 /* Set resources. Create the widget. The background of the
4513 Xaw3d scroll bar widget is a little bit light for my taste.
4514 We don't alter it here to let users change it according
4515 to their taste with `emacs*verticalScrollBar.background: xxx'. */
4516 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4517 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNorientation, XtorientVertical); ++ac;
4518 /* For smoother scrolling with Xaw3d -sm */
4519 /* XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNpickTop, True); ++ac; */
4520
4521 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4522 if (pixel != -1)
4523 {
4524 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNforeground, pixel);
4525 ++ac;
4526 }
4527
4528 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4529 if (pixel != -1)
4530 {
4531 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbackground, pixel);
4532 ++ac;
4533 }
4534
4535 /* Top/bottom shadow colors. */
4536
4537 /* Allocate them, if necessary. */
4538 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1)
4539 {
4540 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4541 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4542 &pixel, 1.2, 0x8000))
4543 pixel = -1;
4544 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4545 }
4546 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4547 {
4548 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4549 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4550 &pixel, 0.6, 0x4000))
4551 pixel = -1;
4552 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4553 }
4554
4555 #ifdef XtNbeNiceToColormap
4556 /* Tell the toolkit about them. */
4557 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1
4558 || f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4559 /* We tried to allocate a color for the top/bottom shadow, and
4560 failed, so tell Xaw3d to use dithering instead. */
4561 {
4562 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, True);
4563 ++ac;
4564 }
4565 else
4566 /* Tell what colors Xaw3d should use for the top/bottom shadow, to
4567 be more consistent with other emacs 3d colors, and since Xaw3d is
4568 not good at dealing with allocation failure. */
4569 {
4570 /* This tells Xaw3d to use real colors instead of dithering for
4571 the shadows. */
4572 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, False);
4573 ++ac;
4574
4575 /* Specify the colors. */
4576 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel;
4577 if (pixel != -1)
4578 {
4579 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNtopShadowPixel, pixel);
4580 ++ac;
4581 }
4582 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel;
4583 if (pixel != -1)
4584 {
4585 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbottomShadowPixel, pixel);
4586 ++ac;
4587 }
4588 }
4589 #endif
4590
4591 widget = XtCreateWidget (scroll_bar_name, scrollbarWidgetClass,
4592 f->output_data.x->edit_widget, av, ac);
4593
4594 {
4595 char *initial = "";
4596 char *val = initial;
4597 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNscrollVCursor, (XtPointer) &val,
4598 #ifdef XtNarrowScrollbars
4599 XtNarrowScrollbars, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_arrow_scroll,
4600 #endif
4601 XtNpickTop, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_pick_top, NULL);
4602 if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll || val == initial)
4603 { /* ARROW_SCROLL */
4604 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = True;
4605 /* Isn't that just a personal preference ? --Stef */
4606 XtVaSetValues (widget, XtNcursorName, "top_left_arrow", NULL);
4607 }
4608 }
4609
4610 /* Define callbacks. */
4611 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNjumpProc, xaw_jump_callback, (XtPointer) bar);
4612 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNscrollProc, xaw_scroll_callback,
4613 (XtPointer) bar);
4614
4615 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4616 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4617
4618 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4619
4620 /* Install an action hook that lets us detect when the user
4621 finishes interacting with a scroll bar. */
4622 if (action_hook_id == 0)
4623 action_hook_id = XtAppAddActionHook (Xt_app_con, xt_action_hook, 0);
4624
4625 /* Remember X window and widget in the scroll bar vector. */
4626 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (bar, widget);
4627 xwindow = XtWindow (widget);
4628 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar, xwindow);
4629
4630 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4631 }
4632 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4633
4634
4635 /* Set the thumb size and position of scroll bar BAR. We are currently
4636 displaying PORTION out of a whole WHOLE, and our position POSITION. */
4637
4638 #ifdef USE_GTK
4639 static void
4640 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole)
4641 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4642 int portion, position, whole;
4643 {
4644 xg_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
4645 }
4646
4647 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4648 static void
4649 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole)
4650 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4651 int portion, position, whole;
4652 {
4653 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4654 Widget widget = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4655 float top, shown;
4656
4657 BLOCK_INPUT;
4658
4659 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4660
4661 /* We use an estimate of 30 chars per line rather than the real
4662 `portion' value. This has the disadvantage that the thumb size
4663 is not very representative, but it makes our life a lot easier.
4664 Otherwise, we have to constantly adjust the thumb size, which
4665 we can't always do quickly enough: while dragging, the size of
4666 the thumb might prevent the user from dragging the thumb all the
4667 way to the end. but Motif and some versions of Xaw3d don't allow
4668 updating the thumb size while dragging. Also, even if we can update
4669 its size, the update will often happen too late.
4670 If you don't believe it, check out revision 1.650 of xterm.c to see
4671 what hoops we were going through and the still poor behavior we got. */
4672 portion = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (bar->window)) * 30;
4673 /* When the thumb is at the bottom, position == whole.
4674 So we need to increase `whole' to make space for the thumb. */
4675 whole += portion;
4676
4677 if (whole <= 0)
4678 top = 0, shown = 1;
4679 else
4680 {
4681 top = (float) position / whole;
4682 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4683 }
4684
4685 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4686 {
4687 int size, value;
4688
4689 /* Slider size. Must be in the range [1 .. MAX - MIN] where MAX
4690 is the scroll bar's maximum and MIN is the scroll bar's minimum
4691 value. */
4692 size = shown * XM_SB_MAX;
4693 size = min (size, XM_SB_MAX);
4694 size = max (size, 1);
4695
4696 /* Position. Must be in the range [MIN .. MAX - SLIDER_SIZE]. */
4697 value = top * XM_SB_MAX;
4698 value = min (value, XM_SB_MAX - size);
4699
4700 XmScrollBarSetValues (widget, value, size, 0, 0, False);
4701 }
4702 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4703
4704 if (whole == 0)
4705 top = 0, shown = 1;
4706 else
4707 {
4708 top = (float) position / whole;
4709 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4710 }
4711
4712 {
4713 float old_top, old_shown;
4714 Dimension height;
4715 XtVaGetValues (widget,
4716 XtNtopOfThumb, &old_top,
4717 XtNshown, &old_shown,
4718 XtNheight, &height,
4719 NULL);
4720
4721 /* Massage the top+shown values. */
4722 if (NILP (bar->dragging) || last_scroll_bar_part == scroll_bar_down_arrow)
4723 top = max (0, min (1, top));
4724 else
4725 top = old_top;
4726 /* Keep two pixels available for moving the thumb down. */
4727 shown = max (0, min (1 - top - (2.0 / height), shown));
4728
4729 /* If the call to XawScrollbarSetThumb below doesn't seem to work,
4730 check that your system's configuration file contains a define
4731 for `NARROWPROTO'. See s/freebsd.h for an example. */
4732 if (top != old_top || shown != old_shown)
4733 {
4734 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4735 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4736 else
4737 {
4738 /* Try to make the scrolling a tad smoother. */
4739 if (!xaw3d_pick_top)
4740 shown = min (shown, old_shown);
4741
4742 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4743 }
4744 }
4745 }
4746 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4747
4748 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4749 }
4750 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4751
4752 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4753
4754
4755 \f
4756 /************************************************************************
4757 Scroll bars, general
4758 ************************************************************************/
4759
4760 /* Create a scroll bar and return the scroll bar vector for it. W is
4761 the Emacs window on which to create the scroll bar. TOP, LEFT,
4762 WIDTH and HEIGHT are the pixel coordinates and dimensions of the
4763 scroll bar. */
4764
4765 static struct scroll_bar *
4766 x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, left, width, height)
4767 struct window *w;
4768 int top, left, width, height;
4769 {
4770 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4771 struct scroll_bar *bar
4772 = XSCROLL_BAR (Fmake_vector (make_number (SCROLL_BAR_VEC_SIZE), Qnil));
4773
4774 BLOCK_INPUT;
4775
4776 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4777 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar);
4778 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4779 {
4780 XSetWindowAttributes a;
4781 unsigned long mask;
4782 Window window;
4783
4784 a.background_pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4785 if (a.background_pixel == -1)
4786 a.background_pixel = f->output_data.x->background_pixel;
4787
4788 a.event_mask = (ButtonPressMask | ButtonReleaseMask
4789 | ButtonMotionMask | PointerMotionHintMask
4790 | ExposureMask);
4791 a.cursor = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor;
4792
4793 mask = (CWBackPixel | CWEventMask | CWCursor);
4794
4795 /* Clear the area of W that will serve as a scroll bar. This is
4796 for the case that a window has been split horizontally. In
4797 this case, no clear_frame is generated to reduce flickering. */
4798 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
4799 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4800 left, top, width,
4801 window_box_height (w), False);
4802
4803 window = XCreateWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4804 /* Position and size of scroll bar. */
4805 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4806 top,
4807 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4808 height,
4809 /* Border width, depth, class, and visual. */
4810 0,
4811 CopyFromParent,
4812 CopyFromParent,
4813 CopyFromParent,
4814 /* Attributes. */
4815 mask, &a);
4816 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar, window);
4817 }
4818 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4819
4820 XSETWINDOW (bar->window, w);
4821 XSETINT (bar->top, top);
4822 XSETINT (bar->left, left);
4823 XSETINT (bar->width, width);
4824 XSETINT (bar->height, height);
4825 XSETINT (bar->start, 0);
4826 XSETINT (bar->end, 0);
4827 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4828
4829 /* Add bar to its frame's list of scroll bars. */
4830 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
4831 bar->prev = Qnil;
4832 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
4833 if (!NILP (bar->next))
4834 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
4835
4836 /* Map the window/widget. */
4837 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4838 {
4839 #ifdef USE_GTK
4840 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
4841 SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar),
4842 top,
4843 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4844 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4845 max (height, 1));
4846 xg_show_scroll_bar (SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar));
4847 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4848 Widget scroll_bar = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4849 XtConfigureWidget (scroll_bar,
4850 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4851 top,
4852 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4853 max (height, 1), 0);
4854 XtMapWidget (scroll_bar);
4855 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4856 }
4857 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4858 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar));
4859 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4860
4861 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4862 return bar;
4863 }
4864
4865
4866 /* Draw BAR's handle in the proper position.
4867
4868 If the handle is already drawn from START to END, don't bother
4869 redrawing it, unless REBUILD is non-zero; in that case, always
4870 redraw it. (REBUILD is handy for drawing the handle after expose
4871 events.)
4872
4873 Normally, we want to constrain the start and end of the handle to
4874 fit inside its rectangle, but if the user is dragging the scroll
4875 bar handle, we want to let them drag it down all the way, so that
4876 the bar's top is as far down as it goes; otherwise, there's no way
4877 to move to the very end of the buffer. */
4878
4879 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4880
4881 static void
4882 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, rebuild)
4883 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4884 int start, end;
4885 int rebuild;
4886 {
4887 int dragging = ! NILP (bar->dragging);
4888 Window w = SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar);
4889 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4890 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
4891
4892 /* If the display is already accurate, do nothing. */
4893 if (! rebuild
4894 && start == XINT (bar->start)
4895 && end == XINT (bar->end))
4896 return;
4897
4898 BLOCK_INPUT;
4899
4900 {
4901 int inside_width = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_WIDTH (f, XINT (bar->width));
4902 int inside_height = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, XINT (bar->height));
4903 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, XINT (bar->height));
4904
4905 /* Make sure the values are reasonable, and try to preserve
4906 the distance between start and end. */
4907 {
4908 int length = end - start;
4909
4910 if (start < 0)
4911 start = 0;
4912 else if (start > top_range)
4913 start = top_range;
4914 end = start + length;
4915
4916 if (end < start)
4917 end = start;
4918 else if (end > top_range && ! dragging)
4919 end = top_range;
4920 }
4921
4922 /* Store the adjusted setting in the scroll bar. */
4923 XSETINT (bar->start, start);
4924 XSETINT (bar->end, end);
4925
4926 /* Clip the end position, just for display. */
4927 if (end > top_range)
4928 end = top_range;
4929
4930 /* Draw bottom positions VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE pixels
4931 below top positions, to make sure the handle is always at least
4932 that many pixels tall. */
4933 end += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE;
4934
4935 /* Draw the empty space above the handle. Note that we can't clear
4936 zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
4937 if (0 < start)
4938 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
4939 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
4940 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
4941 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER,
4942 inside_width, start,
4943 False);
4944
4945 /* Change to proper foreground color if one is specified. */
4946 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
4947 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
4948 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
4949
4950 /* Draw the handle itself. */
4951 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
4952 /* x, y, width, height */
4953 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
4954 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + start,
4955 inside_width, end - start);
4956
4957 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
4958 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
4959 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
4960 f->output_data.x->foreground_pixel);
4961
4962 /* Draw the empty space below the handle. Note that we can't
4963 clear zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
4964 if (end < inside_height)
4965 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
4966 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
4967 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
4968 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + end,
4969 inside_width, inside_height - end,
4970 False);
4971
4972 }
4973
4974 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4975 }
4976
4977 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4978
4979 /* Destroy scroll bar BAR, and set its Emacs window's scroll bar to
4980 nil. */
4981
4982 static void
4983 x_scroll_bar_remove (bar)
4984 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4985 {
4986 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4987 BLOCK_INPUT;
4988
4989 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4990 #ifdef USE_GTK
4991 xg_remove_scroll_bar (f, SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar));
4992 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4993 XtDestroyWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar));
4994 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4995 #else
4996 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar));
4997 #endif
4998
4999 /* Disassociate this scroll bar from its window. */
5000 XWINDOW (bar->window)->vertical_scroll_bar = Qnil;
5001
5002 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5003 }
5004
5005
5006 /* Set the handle of the vertical scroll bar for WINDOW to indicate
5007 that we are displaying PORTION characters out of a total of WHOLE
5008 characters, starting at POSITION. If WINDOW has no scroll bar,
5009 create one. */
5010
5011 static void
5012 XTset_vertical_scroll_bar (w, portion, whole, position)
5013 struct window *w;
5014 int portion, whole, position;
5015 {
5016 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
5017 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5018 int top, height, left, sb_left, width, sb_width;
5019 int window_y, window_height;
5020
5021 /* Get window dimensions. */
5022 window_box (w, -1, 0, &window_y, 0, &window_height);
5023 top = window_y;
5024 width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5025 height = window_height;
5026
5027 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar area. */
5028 left = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
5029
5030 /* Compute the width of the scroll bar which might be less than
5031 the width of the area reserved for the scroll bar. */
5032 if (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w) > 0)
5033 sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
5034 else
5035 sb_width = width;
5036
5037 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar. */
5038 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5039 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5040 sb_left = (left +
5041 (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
5042 ? width - sb_width - (width - sb_width) / 2
5043 : 0));
5044 else
5045 sb_left = (left +
5046 (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
5047 ? (width - sb_width) / 2
5048 : width - sb_width));
5049 #else
5050 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5051 sb_left = left + width - sb_width;
5052 else
5053 sb_left = left;
5054 #endif
5055
5056 /* Does the scroll bar exist yet? */
5057 if (NILP (w->vertical_scroll_bar))
5058 {
5059 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5060 {
5061 BLOCK_INPUT;
5062 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5063 left, top, width, height, False);
5064 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5065 }
5066
5067 bar = x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, sb_left, sb_width, height);
5068 }
5069 else
5070 {
5071 /* It may just need to be moved and resized. */
5072 unsigned int mask = 0;
5073
5074 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar);
5075
5076 BLOCK_INPUT;
5077
5078 if (sb_left != XINT (bar->left))
5079 mask |= CWX;
5080 if (top != XINT (bar->top))
5081 mask |= CWY;
5082 if (sb_width != XINT (bar->width))
5083 mask |= CWWidth;
5084 if (height != XINT (bar->height))
5085 mask |= CWHeight;
5086
5087 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5088
5089 /* Move/size the scroll bar widget. */
5090 if (mask)
5091 {
5092 /* Since toolkit scroll bars are smaller than the space reserved
5093 for them on the frame, we have to clear "under" them. */
5094 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5095 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5096 left, top, width, height, False);
5097 #ifdef USE_GTK
5098 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
5099 SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar),
5100 top,
5101 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5102 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM *2,
5103 max (height, 1));
5104 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5105 XtConfigureWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar),
5106 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5107 top,
5108 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5109 max (height, 1), 0);
5110 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5111 }
5112 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5113
5114 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because of
5115 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM. */
5116 if (VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM)
5117 {
5118 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5119 left, top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5120 height, False);
5121 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5122 left + width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5123 top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5124 height, False);
5125 }
5126
5127 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because it's not as
5128 wide as the area reserved for it. This makes sure a
5129 previous mode line display is cleared after C-x 2 C-x 1, for
5130 example. */
5131 {
5132 int area_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5133 int rest = area_width - sb_width;
5134 if (rest > 0 && height > 0)
5135 {
5136 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5137 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5138 left + area_width - rest, top,
5139 rest, height, False);
5140 else
5141 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5142 left, top, rest, height, False);
5143 }
5144 }
5145
5146 /* Move/size the scroll bar window. */
5147 if (mask)
5148 {
5149 XWindowChanges wc;
5150
5151 wc.x = sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5152 wc.y = top;
5153 wc.width = sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2;
5154 wc.height = height;
5155 XConfigureWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar),
5156 mask, &wc);
5157 }
5158
5159 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5160
5161 /* Remember new settings. */
5162 XSETINT (bar->left, sb_left);
5163 XSETINT (bar->top, top);
5164 XSETINT (bar->width, sb_width);
5165 XSETINT (bar->height, height);
5166
5167 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5168 }
5169
5170 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5171 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
5172 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5173 /* Set the scroll bar's current state, unless we're currently being
5174 dragged. */
5175 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
5176 {
5177 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, height);
5178
5179 if (whole == 0)
5180 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, 0, top_range, 0);
5181 else
5182 {
5183 int start = ((double) position * top_range) / whole;
5184 int end = ((double) (position + portion) * top_range) / whole;
5185 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, 0);
5186 }
5187 }
5188 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5189
5190 XSETVECTOR (w->vertical_scroll_bar, bar);
5191 }
5192
5193
5194 /* The following three hooks are used when we're doing a thorough
5195 redisplay of the frame. We don't explicitly know which scroll bars
5196 are going to be deleted, because keeping track of when windows go
5197 away is a real pain - "Can you say set-window-configuration, boys
5198 and girls?" Instead, we just assert at the beginning of redisplay
5199 that *all* scroll bars are to be removed, and then save a scroll bar
5200 from the fiery pit when we actually redisplay its window. */
5201
5202 /* Arrange for all scroll bars on FRAME to be removed at the next call
5203 to `*judge_scroll_bars_hook'. A scroll bar may be spared if
5204 `*redeem_scroll_bar_hook' is applied to its window before the judgment. */
5205
5206 static void
5207 XTcondemn_scroll_bars (frame)
5208 FRAME_PTR frame;
5209 {
5210 /* Transfer all the scroll bars to FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS. */
5211 while (! NILP (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5212 {
5213 Lisp_Object bar;
5214 bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5215 FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next;
5216 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5217 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->prev = Qnil;
5218 if (! NILP (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5219 XSCROLL_BAR (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame))->prev = bar;
5220 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = bar;
5221 }
5222 }
5223
5224
5225 /* Un-mark WINDOW's scroll bar for deletion in this judgment cycle.
5226 Note that WINDOW isn't necessarily condemned at all. */
5227
5228 static void
5229 XTredeem_scroll_bar (window)
5230 struct window *window;
5231 {
5232 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5233 struct frame *f;
5234
5235 /* We can't redeem this window's scroll bar if it doesn't have one. */
5236 if (NILP (window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5237 abort ();
5238
5239 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (window->vertical_scroll_bar);
5240
5241 /* Unlink it from the condemned list. */
5242 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (window));
5243 if (NILP (bar->prev))
5244 {
5245 /* If the prev pointer is nil, it must be the first in one of
5246 the lists. */
5247 if (EQ (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5248 /* It's not condemned. Everything's fine. */
5249 return;
5250 else if (EQ (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f),
5251 window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5252 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = bar->next;
5253 else
5254 /* If its prev pointer is nil, it must be at the front of
5255 one or the other! */
5256 abort ();
5257 }
5258 else
5259 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->prev)->next = bar->next;
5260
5261 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5262 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev = bar->prev;
5263
5264 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5265 bar->prev = Qnil;
5266 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
5267 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5268 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
5269 }
5270
5271 /* Remove all scroll bars on FRAME that haven't been saved since the
5272 last call to `*condemn_scroll_bars_hook'. */
5273
5274 static void
5275 XTjudge_scroll_bars (f)
5276 FRAME_PTR f;
5277 {
5278 Lisp_Object bar, next;
5279
5280 bar = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5281
5282 /* Clear out the condemned list now so we won't try to process any
5283 more events on the hapless scroll bars. */
5284 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = Qnil;
5285
5286 for (; ! NILP (bar); bar = next)
5287 {
5288 struct scroll_bar *b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
5289
5290 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
5291
5292 next = b->next;
5293 b->next = b->prev = Qnil;
5294 }
5295
5296 /* Now there should be no references to the condemned scroll bars,
5297 and they should get garbage-collected. */
5298 }
5299
5300
5301 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5302 /* Handle an Expose or GraphicsExpose event on a scroll bar. This
5303 is a no-op when using toolkit scroll bars.
5304
5305 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5306 mark bits. */
5307
5308 static void
5309 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, event)
5310 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5311 XEvent *event;
5312 {
5313 Window w = SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar);
5314 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5315 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
5316 int width_trim = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5317
5318 BLOCK_INPUT;
5319
5320 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, XINT (bar->start), XINT (bar->end), 1);
5321
5322 /* Draw a one-pixel border just inside the edges of the scroll bar. */
5323 XDrawRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5324
5325 /* x, y, width, height */
5326 0, 0,
5327 XINT (bar->width) - 1 - width_trim - width_trim,
5328 XINT (bar->height) - 1);
5329
5330 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5331
5332 }
5333 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5334
5335 /* Handle a mouse click on the scroll bar BAR. If *EMACS_EVENT's kind
5336 is set to something other than NO_EVENT, it is enqueued.
5337
5338 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5339 mark bits. */
5340
5341
5342 static void
5343 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, event, emacs_event)
5344 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5345 XEvent *event;
5346 struct input_event *emacs_event;
5347 {
5348 if (! GC_WINDOWP (bar->window))
5349 abort ();
5350
5351 emacs_event->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
5352 emacs_event->code = event->xbutton.button - Button1;
5353 emacs_event->modifiers
5354 = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO
5355 (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)))),
5356 event->xbutton.state)
5357 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
5358 ? up_modifier
5359 : down_modifier));
5360 emacs_event->frame_or_window = bar->window;
5361 emacs_event->arg = Qnil;
5362 emacs_event->timestamp = event->xbutton.time;
5363 {
5364 #if 0
5365 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5366 int internal_height
5367 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, XINT (bar->height));
5368 #endif
5369 int top_range
5370 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, XINT (bar->height));
5371 int y = event->xbutton.y - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5372
5373 if (y < 0) y = 0;
5374 if (y > top_range) y = top_range;
5375
5376 if (y < XINT (bar->start))
5377 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5378 else if (y < XINT (bar->end) + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5379 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_handle;
5380 else
5381 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5382
5383 /* Just because the user has clicked on the handle doesn't mean
5384 they want to drag it. Lisp code needs to be able to decide
5385 whether or not we're dragging. */
5386 #if 0
5387 /* If the user has just clicked on the handle, record where they're
5388 holding it. */
5389 if (event->type == ButtonPress
5390 && emacs_event->part == scroll_bar_handle)
5391 XSETINT (bar->dragging, y - XINT (bar->start));
5392 #endif
5393
5394 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5395 /* If the user has released the handle, set it to its final position. */
5396 if (event->type == ButtonRelease
5397 && ! NILP (bar->dragging))
5398 {
5399 int new_start = y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5400 int new_end = new_start + (XINT (bar->end) - XINT (bar->start));
5401
5402 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5403 bar->dragging = Qnil;
5404 }
5405 #endif
5406
5407 /* Same deal here as the other #if 0. */
5408 #if 0
5409 /* Clicks on the handle are always reported as occurring at the top of
5410 the handle. */
5411 if (emacs_event->part == scroll_bar_handle)
5412 emacs_event->x = bar->start;
5413 else
5414 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, y);
5415 #else
5416 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, y);
5417 #endif
5418
5419 XSETINT (emacs_event->y, top_range);
5420 }
5421 }
5422
5423 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5424
5425 /* Handle some mouse motion while someone is dragging the scroll bar.
5426
5427 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5428 mark bits. */
5429
5430 static void
5431 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, event)
5432 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5433 XEvent *event;
5434 {
5435 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)->frame);
5436
5437 last_mouse_movement_time = event->xmotion.time;
5438
5439 f->mouse_moved = 1;
5440 XSETVECTOR (last_mouse_scroll_bar, bar);
5441
5442 /* If we're dragging the bar, display it. */
5443 if (! GC_NILP (bar->dragging))
5444 {
5445 /* Where should the handle be now? */
5446 int new_start = event->xmotion.y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5447
5448 if (new_start != XINT (bar->start))
5449 {
5450 int new_end = new_start + (XINT (bar->end) - XINT (bar->start));
5451
5452 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5453 }
5454 }
5455 }
5456
5457 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5458
5459 /* Return information to the user about the current position of the mouse
5460 on the scroll bar. */
5461
5462 static void
5463 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, time)
5464 FRAME_PTR *fp;
5465 Lisp_Object *bar_window;
5466 enum scroll_bar_part *part;
5467 Lisp_Object *x, *y;
5468 unsigned long *time;
5469 {
5470 struct scroll_bar *bar = XSCROLL_BAR (last_mouse_scroll_bar);
5471 Window w = SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar);
5472 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5473 int win_x, win_y;
5474 Window dummy_window;
5475 int dummy_coord;
5476 unsigned int dummy_mask;
5477
5478 BLOCK_INPUT;
5479
5480 /* Get the mouse's position relative to the scroll bar window, and
5481 report that. */
5482 if (! XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5483
5484 /* Root, child, root x and root y. */
5485 &dummy_window, &dummy_window,
5486 &dummy_coord, &dummy_coord,
5487
5488 /* Position relative to scroll bar. */
5489 &win_x, &win_y,
5490
5491 /* Mouse buttons and modifier keys. */
5492 &dummy_mask))
5493 ;
5494 else
5495 {
5496 #if 0
5497 int inside_height
5498 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, XINT (bar->height));
5499 #endif
5500 int top_range
5501 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, XINT (bar->height));
5502
5503 win_y -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5504
5505 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5506 win_y -= XINT (bar->dragging);
5507
5508 if (win_y < 0)
5509 win_y = 0;
5510 if (win_y > top_range)
5511 win_y = top_range;
5512
5513 *fp = f;
5514 *bar_window = bar->window;
5515
5516 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5517 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5518 else if (win_y < XINT (bar->start))
5519 *part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5520 else if (win_y < XINT (bar->end) + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5521 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5522 else
5523 *part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5524
5525 XSETINT (*x, win_y);
5526 XSETINT (*y, top_range);
5527
5528 f->mouse_moved = 0;
5529 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
5530 }
5531
5532 *time = last_mouse_movement_time;
5533
5534 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5535 }
5536
5537
5538 /* The screen has been cleared so we may have changed foreground or
5539 background colors, and the scroll bars may need to be redrawn.
5540 Clear out the scroll bars, and ask for expose events, so we can
5541 redraw them. */
5542
5543 void
5544 x_scroll_bar_clear (f)
5545 FRAME_PTR f;
5546 {
5547 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5548 Lisp_Object bar;
5549
5550 /* We can have scroll bars even if this is 0,
5551 if we just turned off scroll bar mode.
5552 But in that case we should not clear them. */
5553 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
5554 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); VECTORP (bar);
5555 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
5556 XClearArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5557 SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (XSCROLL_BAR (bar)),
5558 0, 0, 0, 0, True);
5559 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5560 }
5561
5562 \f
5563 /* The main X event-reading loop - XTread_socket. */
5564
5565 #if 0
5566 /* Time stamp of enter window event. This is only used by XTread_socket,
5567 but we have to put it out here, since static variables within functions
5568 sometimes don't work. */
5569
5570 static Time enter_timestamp;
5571 #endif
5572
5573 /* This holds the state XLookupString needs to implement dead keys
5574 and other tricks known as "compose processing". _X Window System_
5575 says that a portable program can't use this, but Stephen Gildea assures
5576 me that letting the compiler initialize it to zeros will work okay.
5577
5578 This must be defined outside of XTread_socket, for the same reasons
5579 given for enter_timestamp, above. */
5580
5581 static XComposeStatus compose_status;
5582
5583 /* Record the last 100 characters stored
5584 to help debug the loss-of-chars-during-GC problem. */
5585
5586 static int temp_index;
5587 static short temp_buffer[100];
5588
5589 #define STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG(keysym) \
5590 if (temp_index == sizeof temp_buffer / sizeof (short)) \
5591 temp_index = 0; \
5592 temp_buffer[temp_index++] = (keysym)
5593
5594 /* Set this to nonzero to fake an "X I/O error"
5595 on a particular display. */
5596
5597 struct x_display_info *XTread_socket_fake_io_error;
5598
5599 /* When we find no input here, we occasionally do a no-op command
5600 to verify that the X server is still running and we can still talk with it.
5601 We try all the open displays, one by one.
5602 This variable is used for cycling thru the displays. */
5603
5604 static struct x_display_info *next_noop_dpyinfo;
5605
5606 #define SET_SAVED_MENU_EVENT(size) \
5607 do \
5608 { \
5609 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event == 0) \
5610 f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event \
5611 = (XEvent *) xmalloc (sizeof (XEvent)); \
5612 bcopy (&event, f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event, size); \
5613 inev.ie.kind = MENU_BAR_ACTIVATE_EVENT; \
5614 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f); \
5615 } \
5616 while (0)
5617
5618 #define SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT SET_SAVED_MENU_EVENT (sizeof (XButtonEvent))
5619 #define SET_SAVED_KEY_EVENT SET_SAVED_MENU_EVENT (sizeof (XKeyEvent))
5620
5621
5622 enum
5623 {
5624 X_EVENT_NORMAL,
5625 X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT,
5626 X_EVENT_DROP
5627 };
5628
5629 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5630 DPYINFO is the display this event is for.
5631 EVENT is the X event to filter.
5632
5633 Returns non-zero if the event was filtered, caller shall not process
5634 this event further.
5635 Returns zero if event is wasn't filtered. */
5636
5637 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5638 static int
5639 x_filter_event (dpyinfo, event)
5640 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5641 XEvent *event;
5642 {
5643 /* XFilterEvent returns non-zero if the input method has
5644 consumed the event. We pass the frame's X window to
5645 XFilterEvent because that's the one for which the IC
5646 was created. */
5647
5648 struct frame *f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5649 event->xclient.window);
5650
5651 return XFilterEvent (event, f1 ? FRAME_X_WINDOW (f1) : None);
5652 }
5653 #endif
5654
5655 #ifdef USE_GTK
5656 static int current_count;
5657 static int current_finish;
5658 static struct input_event *current_hold_quit;
5659
5660 /* This is the filter function invoked by the GTK event loop.
5661 It is invoked before the XEvent is translated to a GdkEvent,
5662 so we have a chance to act on the event before GTK. */
5663 static GdkFilterReturn
5664 event_handler_gdk (gxev, ev, data)
5665 GdkXEvent *gxev;
5666 GdkEvent *ev;
5667 gpointer data;
5668 {
5669 XEvent *xev = (XEvent *) gxev;
5670
5671 if (current_count >= 0)
5672 {
5673 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5674
5675 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (xev->xany.display);
5676
5677 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5678 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5679 GTK calls XFilterEvent but not for key press and release,
5680 so we do it here. */
5681 if (xev->type == KeyPress || xev->type == KeyRelease)
5682 if (dpyinfo && x_filter_event (dpyinfo, xev))
5683 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5684 #endif
5685
5686 if (! dpyinfo)
5687 current_finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5688 else
5689 {
5690 current_count +=
5691 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, xev, &current_finish,
5692 current_hold_quit);
5693 }
5694 }
5695 else
5696 current_finish = x_dispatch_event (xev, xev->xany.display);
5697
5698 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT || current_finish == X_EVENT_DROP)
5699 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5700
5701 return GDK_FILTER_CONTINUE;
5702 }
5703 #endif /* USE_GTK */
5704
5705
5706 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DPYINFO.
5707
5708 *FINISH is X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT if caller should stop reading events.
5709 *FINISH is zero if caller should continue reading events.
5710 *FINISH is X_EVENT_DROP if event should not be passed to the toolkit.
5711
5712 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer. */
5713
5714 static int
5715 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, eventp, finish, hold_quit)
5716 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5717 XEvent *eventp;
5718 int *finish;
5719 struct input_event *hold_quit;
5720 {
5721 union {
5722 struct input_event ie;
5723 struct selection_input_event sie;
5724 } inev;
5725 int count = 0;
5726 int do_help = 0;
5727 int nbytes = 0;
5728 struct frame *f;
5729 struct coding_system coding;
5730 XEvent event = *eventp;
5731
5732 *finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5733
5734 EVENT_INIT (inev.ie);
5735 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT;
5736 inev.ie.arg = Qnil;
5737
5738 switch (event.type)
5739 {
5740 case ClientMessage:
5741 {
5742 if (event.xclient.message_type
5743 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
5744 && event.xclient.format == 32)
5745 {
5746 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5747 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus)
5748 {
5749 /* Use x_any_window_to_frame because this
5750 could be the shell widget window
5751 if the frame has no title bar. */
5752 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5753 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5754 /* Not quite sure this is needed -pd */
5755 if (f && FRAME_XIC (f))
5756 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (f));
5757 #endif
5758 #if 0 /* Emacs sets WM hints whose `input' field is `true'. This
5759 instructs the WM to set the input focus automatically for
5760 Emacs with a call to XSetInputFocus. Setting WM_TAKE_FOCUS
5761 tells the WM to send us a ClientMessage WM_TAKE_FOCUS after
5762 it has set the focus. So, XSetInputFocus below is not
5763 needed.
5764
5765 The call to XSetInputFocus below has also caused trouble. In
5766 cases where the XSetInputFocus done by the WM and the one
5767 below are temporally close (on a fast machine), the call
5768 below can generate additional FocusIn events which confuse
5769 Emacs. */
5770
5771 /* Since we set WM_TAKE_FOCUS, we must call
5772 XSetInputFocus explicitly. But not if f is null,
5773 since that might be an event for a deleted frame. */
5774 if (f)
5775 {
5776 Display *d = event.xclient.display;
5777 /* Catch and ignore errors, in case window has been
5778 iconified by a window manager such as GWM. */
5779 int count = x_catch_errors (d);
5780 XSetInputFocus (d, event.xclient.window,
5781 /* The ICCCM says this is
5782 the only valid choice. */
5783 RevertToParent,
5784 event.xclient.data.l[1]);
5785 /* This is needed to detect the error
5786 if there is an error. */
5787 XSync (d, False);
5788 x_uncatch_errors (d, count);
5789 }
5790 /* Not certain about handling scroll bars here */
5791 #endif /* 0 */
5792 goto done;
5793 }
5794
5795 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5796 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself)
5797 {
5798 /* Save state modify the WM_COMMAND property to
5799 something which can reinstate us. This notifies
5800 the session manager, who's looking for such a
5801 PropertyNotify. Can restart processing when
5802 a keyboard or mouse event arrives. */
5803 /* If we have a session manager, don't set this.
5804 KDE will then start two Emacsen, one for the
5805 session manager and one for this. */
5806 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
5807 if (! x_session_have_connection ())
5808 #endif
5809 {
5810 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5811 event.xclient.window);
5812 /* This is just so we only give real data once
5813 for a single Emacs process. */
5814 if (f == SELECTED_FRAME ())
5815 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5816 event.xclient.window,
5817 initial_argv, initial_argc);
5818 else if (f)
5819 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5820 event.xclient.window,
5821 0, 0);
5822 }
5823 goto done;
5824 }
5825
5826 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5827 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window)
5828 {
5829 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5830 event.xclient.window);
5831 if (!f)
5832 goto OTHER; /* May be a dialog that is to be removed */
5833
5834 inev.ie.kind = DELETE_WINDOW_EVENT;
5835 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
5836 goto done;
5837 }
5838
5839 goto done;
5840 }
5841
5842 if (event.xclient.message_type
5843 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied)
5844 {
5845 goto done;
5846 }
5847
5848 if (event.xclient.message_type
5849 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved)
5850 {
5851 int new_x, new_y;
5852 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5853
5854 new_x = event.xclient.data.s[0];
5855 new_y = event.xclient.data.s[1];
5856
5857 if (f)
5858 {
5859 f->left_pos = new_x;
5860 f->top_pos = new_y;
5861 }
5862 goto done;
5863 }
5864
5865 #ifdef HACK_EDITRES
5866 if (event.xclient.message_type
5867 == dpyinfo->Xatom_editres)
5868 {
5869 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5870 _XEditResCheckMessages (f->output_data.x->widget, NULL,
5871 &event, NULL);
5872 goto done;
5873 }
5874 #endif /* HACK_EDITRES */
5875
5876 if ((event.xclient.message_type
5877 == dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE)
5878 || (event.xclient.message_type
5879 == dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE))
5880 {
5881 /* Ghostview job completed. Kill it. We could
5882 reply with "Next" if we received "Page", but we
5883 currently never do because we are interested in
5884 images, only, which should have 1 page. */
5885 Pixmap pixmap = (Pixmap) event.xclient.data.l[1];
5886 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5887 x_kill_gs_process (pixmap, f);
5888 expose_frame (f, 0, 0, 0, 0);
5889 goto done;
5890 }
5891
5892 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5893 /* Scroll bar callbacks send a ClientMessage from which
5894 we construct an input_event. */
5895 if (event.xclient.message_type
5896 == dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar)
5897 {
5898 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (&event, &inev.ie);
5899 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
5900 goto done;
5901 }
5902 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5903
5904 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5905
5906 if (!f)
5907 goto OTHER;
5908
5909 if (x_handle_dnd_message (f, &event.xclient, dpyinfo, &inev.ie))
5910 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
5911 }
5912 break;
5913
5914 case SelectionNotify:
5915 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5916 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselection.requestor))
5917 goto OTHER;
5918 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5919 x_handle_selection_notify (&event.xselection);
5920 break;
5921
5922 case SelectionClear: /* Someone has grabbed ownership. */
5923 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5924 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionclear.window))
5925 goto OTHER;
5926 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5927 {
5928 XSelectionClearEvent *eventp = (XSelectionClearEvent *) &event;
5929
5930 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_CLEAR_EVENT;
5931 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
5932 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
5933 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
5934 inev.ie.frame_or_window = Qnil;
5935 }
5936 break;
5937
5938 case SelectionRequest: /* Someone wants our selection. */
5939 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5940 if (!x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionrequest.owner))
5941 goto OTHER;
5942 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5943 {
5944 XSelectionRequestEvent *eventp
5945 = (XSelectionRequestEvent *) &event;
5946
5947 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_REQUEST_EVENT;
5948 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
5949 SELECTION_EVENT_REQUESTOR (&inev.sie) = eventp->requestor;
5950 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
5951 SELECTION_EVENT_TARGET (&inev.sie) = eventp->target;
5952 SELECTION_EVENT_PROPERTY (&inev.sie) = eventp->property;
5953 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
5954 inev.ie.frame_or_window = Qnil;
5955 }
5956 break;
5957
5958 case PropertyNotify:
5959 #if 0 /* This is plain wrong. In the case that we are waiting for a
5960 PropertyNotify used as an ACK in incremental selection
5961 transfer, the property will be on the receiver's window. */
5962 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT
5963 if (!x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xproperty.window))
5964 goto OTHER;
5965 #endif
5966 #endif
5967 x_handle_property_notify (&event.xproperty);
5968 goto OTHER;
5969
5970 case ReparentNotify:
5971 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xreparent.window);
5972 if (f)
5973 {
5974 int x, y;
5975 f->output_data.x->parent_desc = event.xreparent.parent;
5976 x_real_positions (f, &x, &y);
5977 f->left_pos = x;
5978 f->top_pos = y;
5979
5980 /* Perhaps reparented due to a WM restart. Reset this. */
5981 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
5982 }
5983 goto OTHER;
5984
5985 case Expose:
5986 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xexpose.window);
5987 if (f)
5988 {
5989 x_check_fullscreen (f);
5990
5991 #ifdef USE_GTK
5992 /* This seems to be needed for GTK 2.6. */
5993 x_clear_area (event.xexpose.display,
5994 event.xexpose.window,
5995 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
5996 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height,
5997 FALSE);
5998 #endif
5999 if (f->async_visible == 0)
6000 {
6001 f->async_visible = 1;
6002 f->async_iconified = 0;
6003 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6004 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6005 }
6006 else
6007 expose_frame (f,
6008 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
6009 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height);
6010 }
6011 else
6012 {
6013 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6014 struct scroll_bar *bar;
6015 #endif
6016 #if defined USE_LUCID
6017 /* Submenus of the Lucid menu bar aren't widgets
6018 themselves, so there's no way to dispatch events
6019 to them. Recognize this case separately. */
6020 {
6021 Widget widget
6022 = x_window_to_menu_bar (event.xexpose.window);
6023 if (widget)
6024 xlwmenu_redisplay (widget);
6025 }
6026 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
6027
6028 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6029 /* Dispatch event to the widget. */
6030 goto OTHER;
6031 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6032 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xexpose.display,
6033 event.xexpose.window);
6034
6035 if (bar)
6036 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, &event);
6037 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6038 else
6039 goto OTHER;
6040 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6041 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6042 }
6043 break;
6044
6045 case GraphicsExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6046 source area was obscured or not
6047 available. */
6048 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xgraphicsexpose.drawable);
6049 if (f)
6050 {
6051 expose_frame (f,
6052 event.xgraphicsexpose.x, event.xgraphicsexpose.y,
6053 event.xgraphicsexpose.width,
6054 event.xgraphicsexpose.height);
6055 }
6056 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6057 else
6058 goto OTHER;
6059 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6060 break;
6061
6062 case NoExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6063 source area was completely
6064 available. */
6065 break;
6066
6067 case UnmapNotify:
6068 /* Redo the mouse-highlight after the tooltip has gone. */
6069 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6070 {
6071 tip_window = 0;
6072 redo_mouse_highlight ();
6073 }
6074
6075 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xunmap.window);
6076 if (f) /* F may no longer exist if
6077 the frame was deleted. */
6078 {
6079 /* While a frame is unmapped, display generation is
6080 disabled; you don't want to spend time updating a
6081 display that won't ever be seen. */
6082 f->async_visible = 0;
6083 /* We can't distinguish, from the event, whether the window
6084 has become iconified or invisible. So assume, if it
6085 was previously visible, than now it is iconified.
6086 But x_make_frame_invisible clears both
6087 the visible flag and the iconified flag;
6088 and that way, we know the window is not iconified now. */
6089 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) || FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
6090 {
6091 f->async_iconified = 1;
6092
6093 inev.ie.kind = ICONIFY_EVENT;
6094 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6095 }
6096 }
6097 goto OTHER;
6098
6099 case MapNotify:
6100 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6101 /* The tooltip has been drawn already. Avoid
6102 the SET_FRAME_GARBAGED below. */
6103 goto OTHER;
6104
6105 /* We use x_top_window_to_frame because map events can
6106 come for sub-windows and they don't mean that the
6107 frame is visible. */
6108 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmap.window);
6109 if (f)
6110 {
6111 /* wait_reading_process_output will notice this and update
6112 the frame's display structures.
6113 If we where iconified, we should not set garbaged,
6114 because that stops redrawing on Expose events. This looks
6115 bad if we are called from a recursive event loop
6116 (x_dispatch_event), for example when a dialog is up. */
6117 if (! f->async_iconified)
6118 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6119
6120 f->async_visible = 1;
6121 f->async_iconified = 0;
6122 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6123
6124 if (f->iconified)
6125 {
6126 inev.ie.kind = DEICONIFY_EVENT;
6127 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6128 }
6129 else if (! NILP (Vframe_list)
6130 && ! NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
6131 /* Force a redisplay sooner or later
6132 to update the frame titles
6133 in case this is the second frame. */
6134 record_asynch_buffer_change ();
6135 }
6136 goto OTHER;
6137
6138 case KeyPress:
6139
6140 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6141
6142 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6143 /* Dispatch KeyPress events when in menu. */
6144 if (popup_activated ())
6145 goto OTHER;
6146 #endif
6147
6148 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xkey.window);
6149
6150 if (!dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden && INTEGERP (Vmouse_highlight))
6151 {
6152 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6153 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 1;
6154 }
6155
6156 #if defined USE_MOTIF && defined USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6157 if (f == 0)
6158 {
6159 /* Scroll bars consume key events, but we want
6160 the keys to go to the scroll bar's frame. */
6161 Widget widget = XtWindowToWidget (dpyinfo->display,
6162 event.xkey.window);
6163 if (widget && XmIsScrollBar (widget))
6164 {
6165 widget = XtParent (widget);
6166 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, XtWindow (widget));
6167 }
6168 }
6169 #endif /* USE_MOTIF and USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6170
6171 if (f != 0)
6172 {
6173 KeySym keysym, orig_keysym;
6174 /* al%imercury@uunet.uu.net says that making this 81
6175 instead of 80 fixed a bug whereby meta chars made
6176 his Emacs hang.
6177
6178 It seems that some version of XmbLookupString has
6179 a bug of not returning XBufferOverflow in
6180 status_return even if the input is too long to
6181 fit in 81 bytes. So, we must prepare sufficient
6182 bytes for copy_buffer. 513 bytes (256 chars for
6183 two-byte character set) seems to be a fairly good
6184 approximation. -- 2000.8.10 handa@etl.go.jp */
6185 unsigned char copy_buffer[513];
6186 unsigned char *copy_bufptr = copy_buffer;
6187 int copy_bufsiz = sizeof (copy_buffer);
6188 int modifiers;
6189 Lisp_Object coding_system = Qlatin_1;
6190 Lisp_Object c;
6191
6192 #ifdef USE_GTK
6193 /* Don't pass keys to GTK. A Tab will shift focus to the
6194 tool bar in GTK 2.4. Keys will still go to menus and
6195 dialogs because in that case popup_activated is TRUE
6196 (see above). */
6197 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6198 #endif
6199
6200 event.xkey.state
6201 |= x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
6202 extra_keyboard_modifiers);
6203 modifiers = event.xkey.state;
6204
6205 /* This will have to go some day... */
6206
6207 /* make_lispy_event turns chars into control chars.
6208 Don't do it here because XLookupString is too eager. */
6209 event.xkey.state &= ~ControlMask;
6210 event.xkey.state &= ~(dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask
6211 | dpyinfo->super_mod_mask
6212 | dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask
6213 | dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask);
6214
6215 /* In case Meta is ComposeCharacter,
6216 clear its status. According to Markus Ehrnsperger
6217 Markus.Ehrnsperger@lehrstuhl-bross.physik.uni-muenchen.de
6218 this enables ComposeCharacter to work whether or
6219 not it is combined with Meta. */
6220 if (modifiers & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
6221 bzero (&compose_status, sizeof (compose_status));
6222
6223 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6224 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
6225 {
6226 Status status_return;
6227
6228 coding_system = Vlocale_coding_system;
6229 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6230 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6231 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6232 &status_return);
6233 if (status_return == XBufferOverflow)
6234 {
6235 copy_bufsiz = nbytes + 1;
6236 copy_bufptr = (char *) alloca (copy_bufsiz);
6237 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6238 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6239 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6240 &status_return);
6241 }
6242 /* Xutf8LookupString is a new but already deprecated interface. -stef */
6243 #if 0 && defined X_HAVE_UTF8_STRING
6244 else if (status_return == XLookupKeySym)
6245 { /* Try again but with utf-8. */
6246 coding_system = Qutf_8;
6247 nbytes = Xutf8LookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6248 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6249 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6250 &status_return);
6251 if (status_return == XBufferOverflow)
6252 {
6253 copy_bufsiz = nbytes + 1;
6254 copy_bufptr = (char *) alloca (copy_bufsiz);
6255 nbytes = Xutf8LookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6256 &event.xkey,
6257 copy_bufptr,
6258 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6259 &status_return);
6260 }
6261 }
6262 #endif
6263
6264 if (status_return == XLookupNone)
6265 break;
6266 else if (status_return == XLookupChars)
6267 {
6268 keysym = NoSymbol;
6269 modifiers = 0;
6270 }
6271 else if (status_return != XLookupKeySym
6272 && status_return != XLookupBoth)
6273 abort ();
6274 }
6275 else
6276 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6277 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6278 &compose_status);
6279 #else
6280 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6281 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6282 &compose_status);
6283 #endif
6284
6285 /* If not using XIM/XIC, and a compose sequence is in progress,
6286 we break here. Otherwise, chars_matched is always 0. */
6287 if (compose_status.chars_matched > 0 && nbytes == 0)
6288 break;
6289
6290 bzero (&compose_status, sizeof (compose_status));
6291 orig_keysym = keysym;
6292
6293 /* Common for all keysym input events. */
6294 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6295 inev.ie.modifiers
6296 = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f), modifiers);
6297 inev.ie.timestamp = event.xkey.time;
6298
6299 /* First deal with keysyms which have defined
6300 translations to characters. */
6301 if (keysym >= 32 && keysym < 128)
6302 /* Avoid explicitly decoding each ASCII character. */
6303 {
6304 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6305 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6306 goto done_keysym;
6307 }
6308
6309 /* Now non-ASCII. */
6310 if (HASH_TABLE_P (Vx_keysym_table)
6311 && (NATNUMP (c = Fgethash (make_number (keysym),
6312 Vx_keysym_table,
6313 Qnil))))
6314 {
6315 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (XFASTINT (c))
6316 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6317 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6318 inev.ie.code = XFASTINT (c);
6319 goto done_keysym;
6320 }
6321
6322 /* Random non-modifier sorts of keysyms. */
6323 if (((keysym >= XK_BackSpace && keysym <= XK_Escape)
6324 || keysym == XK_Delete
6325 #ifdef XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6326 || (keysym >= XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6327 && keysym <= XK_ISO_Enter)
6328 #endif
6329 || IsCursorKey (keysym) /* 0xff50 <= x < 0xff60 */
6330 || IsMiscFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xff60 <= x < VARIES */
6331 #ifdef HPUX
6332 /* This recognizes the "extended function
6333 keys". It seems there's no cleaner way.
6334 Test IsModifierKey to avoid handling
6335 mode_switch incorrectly. */
6336 || ((unsigned) (keysym) >= XK_Select
6337 && (unsigned)(keysym) < XK_KP_Space)
6338 #endif
6339 #ifdef XK_dead_circumflex
6340 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_circumflex
6341 #endif
6342 #ifdef XK_dead_grave
6343 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_grave
6344 #endif
6345 #ifdef XK_dead_tilde
6346 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_tilde
6347 #endif
6348 #ifdef XK_dead_diaeresis
6349 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_diaeresis
6350 #endif
6351 #ifdef XK_dead_macron
6352 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_macron
6353 #endif
6354 #ifdef XK_dead_degree
6355 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_degree
6356 #endif
6357 #ifdef XK_dead_acute
6358 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_acute
6359 #endif
6360 #ifdef XK_dead_cedilla
6361 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_cedilla
6362 #endif
6363 #ifdef XK_dead_breve
6364 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_breve
6365 #endif
6366 #ifdef XK_dead_ogonek
6367 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_ogonek
6368 #endif
6369 #ifdef XK_dead_caron
6370 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_caron
6371 #endif
6372 #ifdef XK_dead_doubleacute
6373 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_doubleacute
6374 #endif
6375 #ifdef XK_dead_abovedot
6376 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_abovedot
6377 #endif
6378 || IsKeypadKey (keysym) /* 0xff80 <= x < 0xffbe */
6379 || IsFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xffbe <= x < 0xffe1 */
6380 /* Any "vendor-specific" key is ok. */
6381 || (orig_keysym & (1 << 28))
6382 || (keysym != NoSymbol && nbytes == 0))
6383 && ! (IsModifierKey (orig_keysym)
6384 #ifndef HAVE_X11R5
6385 #ifdef XK_Mode_switch
6386 || ((unsigned)(orig_keysym) == XK_Mode_switch)
6387 #endif
6388 #ifdef XK_Num_Lock
6389 || ((unsigned)(orig_keysym) == XK_Num_Lock)
6390 #endif
6391 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R5 */
6392 /* The symbols from XK_ISO_Lock
6393 to XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6394 don't have real modifiers but
6395 should be treated similarly to
6396 Mode_switch by Emacs. */
6397 #if defined XK_ISO_Lock && defined XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6398 || ((unsigned)(orig_keysym)
6399 >= XK_ISO_Lock
6400 && (unsigned)(orig_keysym)
6401 <= XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock)
6402 #endif
6403 ))
6404 {
6405 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (keysym);
6406 /* make_lispy_event will convert this to a symbolic
6407 key. */
6408 inev.ie.kind = NON_ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6409 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6410 goto done_keysym;
6411 }
6412
6413 { /* Raw bytes, not keysym. */
6414 register int i;
6415 register int c;
6416 int nchars, len;
6417
6418 /* The input should be decoded with `coding_system'
6419 which depends on which X*LookupString function
6420 we used just above and the locale. */
6421 setup_coding_system (coding_system, &coding);
6422 coding.src_multibyte = 0;
6423 coding.dst_multibyte = 1;
6424 /* The input is converted to events, thus we can't
6425 handle composition. Anyway, there's no XIM that
6426 gives us composition information. */
6427 coding.composing = COMPOSITION_DISABLED;
6428
6429 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i++)
6430 {
6431 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (copy_bufptr[i]);
6432 }
6433
6434 {
6435 /* Decode the input data. */
6436 int require;
6437 unsigned char *p;
6438
6439 require = decoding_buffer_size (&coding, nbytes);
6440 p = (unsigned char *) alloca (require);
6441 coding.mode |= CODING_MODE_LAST_BLOCK;
6442 /* We explicitly disable composition handling because
6443 key data should not contain any composition sequence. */
6444 coding.composing = COMPOSITION_DISABLED;
6445 decode_coding (&coding, copy_bufptr, p, nbytes, require);
6446 nbytes = coding.produced;
6447 nchars = coding.produced_char;
6448 copy_bufptr = p;
6449 }
6450
6451 /* Convert the input data to a sequence of
6452 character events. */
6453 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i += len)
6454 {
6455 if (nchars == nbytes)
6456 c = copy_bufptr[i], len = 1;
6457 else
6458 c = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (copy_bufptr + i,
6459 nbytes - i, len);
6460 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (c)
6461 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6462 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6463 inev.ie.code = c;
6464 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
6465 }
6466
6467 /* Previous code updated count by nchars rather than nbytes,
6468 but that seems bogus to me. ++kfs */
6469 count += nbytes;
6470
6471 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT; /* Already stored above. */
6472
6473 if (keysym == NoSymbol)
6474 break;
6475 }
6476 }
6477 done_keysym:
6478 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6479 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6480 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6481 client. */
6482 break;
6483 #else
6484 goto OTHER;
6485 #endif
6486
6487 case KeyRelease:
6488 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6489 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6490 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6491 client. */
6492 break;
6493 #else
6494 goto OTHER;
6495 #endif
6496
6497 case EnterNotify:
6498 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6499
6500 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6501
6502 if (f && x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position)
6503 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = event.xmotion.time + 200;
6504
6505 #if 0
6506 if (event.xcrossing.focus)
6507 {
6508 /* Avoid nasty pop/raise loops. */
6509 if (f && (!(f->auto_raise)
6510 || !(f->auto_lower)
6511 || (event.xcrossing.time - enter_timestamp) > 500))
6512 {
6513 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, f);
6514 enter_timestamp = event.xcrossing.time;
6515 }
6516 }
6517 else if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
6518 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
6519 #endif
6520
6521 /* EnterNotify counts as mouse movement,
6522 so update things that depend on mouse position. */
6523 if (f && !f->output_data.x->hourglass_p)
6524 note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion);
6525 goto OTHER;
6526
6527 case FocusIn:
6528 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6529 goto OTHER;
6530
6531 case LeaveNotify:
6532 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6533
6534 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6535 if (f)
6536 {
6537 if (f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
6538 {
6539 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6540 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6541 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6542 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
6543 }
6544
6545 /* Generate a nil HELP_EVENT to cancel a help-echo.
6546 Do it only if there's something to cancel.
6547 Otherwise, the startup message is cleared when
6548 the mouse leaves the frame. */
6549 if (any_help_event_p)
6550 do_help = -1;
6551 }
6552 goto OTHER;
6553
6554 case FocusOut:
6555 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6556 goto OTHER;
6557
6558 case MotionNotify:
6559 {
6560 previous_help_echo_string = help_echo_string;
6561 help_echo_string = help_echo_object = help_echo_window = Qnil;
6562 help_echo_pos = -1;
6563
6564 if (dpyinfo->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
6565 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6566 f = last_mouse_frame;
6567 else
6568 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmotion.window);
6569
6570 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden)
6571 {
6572 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
6573 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6574 }
6575
6576 if (f)
6577 {
6578
6579 /* Generate SELECT_WINDOW_EVENTs when needed. */
6580 if (mouse_autoselect_window)
6581 {
6582 Lisp_Object window;
6583
6584 window = window_from_coordinates (f,
6585 event.xmotion.x, event.xmotion.y,
6586 0, 0, 0, 0);
6587
6588 /* Window will be selected only when it is not selected now and
6589 last mouse movement event was not in it. Minibuffer window
6590 will be selected iff it is active. */
6591 if (WINDOWP (window)
6592 && !EQ (window, last_window)
6593 && !EQ (window, selected_window))
6594 {
6595 inev.ie.kind = SELECT_WINDOW_EVENT;
6596 inev.ie.frame_or_window = window;
6597 }
6598
6599 last_window=window;
6600 }
6601 note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion);
6602 }
6603 else
6604 {
6605 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6606 struct scroll_bar *bar
6607 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xmotion.display,
6608 event.xmotion.window);
6609
6610 if (bar)
6611 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, &event);
6612 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6613
6614 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6615 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6616 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6617 }
6618
6619 /* If the contents of the global variable help_echo_string
6620 has changed, generate a HELP_EVENT. */
6621 if (!NILP (help_echo_string)
6622 || !NILP (previous_help_echo_string))
6623 do_help = 1;
6624 goto OTHER;
6625 }
6626
6627 case ConfigureNotify:
6628 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window);
6629 if (f)
6630 {
6631 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6632 #ifdef USE_GTK
6633 xg_resize_widgets (f, event.xconfigure.width,
6634 event.xconfigure.height);
6635 #else /* not USE_GTK */
6636 /* If there is a pending resize for fullscreen, don't
6637 do this one, the right one will come later.
6638 The toolkit version doesn't seem to need this, but we
6639 need to reset it below. */
6640 int dont_resize
6641 = ((f->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_WAIT)
6642 && f->new_text_cols != 0);
6643 int rows = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, event.xconfigure.height);
6644 int columns = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, event.xconfigure.width);
6645
6646 if (dont_resize)
6647 goto OTHER;
6648
6649 /* In the toolkit version, change_frame_size
6650 is called by the code that handles resizing
6651 of the EmacsFrame widget. */
6652
6653 /* Even if the number of character rows and columns has
6654 not changed, the font size may have changed, so we need
6655 to check the pixel dimensions as well. */
6656 if (columns != FRAME_COLS (f)
6657 || rows != FRAME_LINES (f)
6658 || event.xconfigure.width != FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6659 || event.xconfigure.height != FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f))
6660 {
6661 change_frame_size (f, rows, columns, 0, 1, 0);
6662 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6663 cancel_mouse_face (f);
6664 }
6665 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
6666 #endif
6667
6668 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = event.xconfigure.width;
6669 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = event.xconfigure.height;
6670
6671 #ifdef USE_GTK
6672 /* GTK creates windows but doesn't map them.
6673 Only get real positions and check fullscreen when mapped. */
6674 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)
6675 && GTK_WIDGET_MAPPED (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)))
6676 #endif
6677 {
6678 /* What we have now is the position of Emacs's own window.
6679 Convert that to the position of the window manager window. */
6680 x_real_positions (f, &f->left_pos, &f->top_pos);
6681
6682 x_check_expected_move (f);
6683 if (f->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_WAIT)
6684 f->want_fullscreen &= ~(FULLSCREEN_WAIT|FULLSCREEN_BOTH);
6685 }
6686
6687 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6688 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea))
6689 xic_set_statusarea (f);
6690 #endif
6691
6692 if (f->output_data.x->parent_desc != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
6693 {
6694 /* Since the WM decorations come below top_pos now,
6695 we must put them below top_pos in the future. */
6696 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
6697 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
6698 }
6699 }
6700 goto OTHER;
6701
6702 case ButtonRelease:
6703 case ButtonPress:
6704 {
6705 /* If we decide we want to generate an event to be seen
6706 by the rest of Emacs, we put it here. */
6707 int tool_bar_p = 0;
6708
6709 bzero (&compose_status, sizeof (compose_status));
6710
6711 if (dpyinfo->grabbed
6712 && last_mouse_frame
6713 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6714 f = last_mouse_frame;
6715 else
6716 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xbutton.window);
6717
6718 if (f)
6719 {
6720 /* Is this in the tool-bar? */
6721 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
6722 && WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window)))
6723 {
6724 Lisp_Object window;
6725 int x = event.xbutton.x;
6726 int y = event.xbutton.y;
6727
6728 window = window_from_coordinates (f, x, y, 0, 0, 0, 1);
6729 if (EQ (window, f->tool_bar_window))
6730 {
6731 if (event.xbutton.type == ButtonPress)
6732 handle_tool_bar_click (f, x, y, 1, 0);
6733 else
6734 handle_tool_bar_click (f, x, y, 0,
6735 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo,
6736 event.xbutton.state));
6737 tool_bar_p = 1;
6738 }
6739 }
6740
6741 if (!tool_bar_p)
6742 if (!dpyinfo->x_focus_frame
6743 || f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
6744 {
6745 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6746 if (! popup_activated ())
6747 #endif
6748 {
6749 if (ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout)
6750 {
6751 if (event.type == ButtonPress
6752 && (int)(event.xbutton.time - ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout) > 0)
6753 {
6754 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6755 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event, f);
6756 }
6757 if (event.type == ButtonRelease)
6758 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6759 }
6760 else
6761 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event, f);
6762 }
6763 }
6764 }
6765 else
6766 {
6767 struct scroll_bar *bar
6768 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xbutton.display,
6769 event.xbutton.window);
6770
6771 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6772 /* Make the "Ctrl-Mouse-2 splits window" work for toolkit
6773 scroll bars. */
6774 if (bar && event.xbutton.state & ControlMask)
6775 {
6776 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
6777 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6778 }
6779 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6780 if (bar)
6781 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
6782 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6783 }
6784
6785 if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6786 {
6787 dpyinfo->grabbed |= (1 << event.xbutton.button);
6788 last_mouse_frame = f;
6789
6790 if (!tool_bar_p)
6791 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
6792 }
6793 else
6794 dpyinfo->grabbed &= ~(1 << event.xbutton.button);
6795
6796 /* Ignore any mouse motion that happened before this event;
6797 any subsequent mouse-movement Emacs events should reflect
6798 only motion after the ButtonPress/Release. */
6799 if (f != 0)
6800 f->mouse_moved = 0;
6801
6802 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6803 f = x_menubar_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xbutton.window);
6804 /* For a down-event in the menu bar,
6805 don't pass it to Xt right now.
6806 Instead, save it away
6807 and we will pass it to Xt from kbd_buffer_get_event.
6808 That way, we can run some Lisp code first. */
6809 if (
6810 #ifdef USE_GTK
6811 ! popup_activated ()
6812 &&
6813 #endif
6814 f && event.type == ButtonPress
6815 /* Verify the event is really within the menu bar
6816 and not just sent to it due to grabbing. */
6817 && event.xbutton.x >= 0
6818 && event.xbutton.x < FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6819 && event.xbutton.y >= 0
6820 && event.xbutton.y < f->output_data.x->menubar_height
6821 && event.xbutton.same_screen)
6822 {
6823 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT;
6824 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame, f);
6825 #ifdef USE_GTK
6826 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6827 #endif
6828 }
6829 else if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6830 {
6831 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
6832 goto OTHER;
6833 }
6834
6835 #ifdef USE_MOTIF /* This should do not harm for Lucid,
6836 but I am trying to be cautious. */
6837 else if (event.type == ButtonRelease)
6838 {
6839 if (!NILP (last_mouse_press_frame))
6840 {
6841 f = XFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame);
6842 if (f->output_data.x)
6843 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT;
6844 }
6845 else
6846 goto OTHER;
6847 }
6848 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
6849 else
6850 goto OTHER;
6851 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT || USE_GTK */
6852 }
6853 break;
6854
6855 case CirculateNotify:
6856 goto OTHER;
6857
6858 case CirculateRequest:
6859 goto OTHER;
6860
6861 case VisibilityNotify:
6862 goto OTHER;
6863
6864 case MappingNotify:
6865 /* Someone has changed the keyboard mapping - update the
6866 local cache. */
6867 switch (event.xmapping.request)
6868 {
6869 case MappingModifier:
6870 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
6871 /* This is meant to fall through. */
6872 case MappingKeyboard:
6873 XRefreshKeyboardMapping (&event.xmapping);
6874 }
6875 goto OTHER;
6876
6877 default:
6878 OTHER:
6879 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6880 BLOCK_INPUT;
6881 if (*finish != X_EVENT_DROP)
6882 XtDispatchEvent (&event);
6883 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
6884 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6885 break;
6886 }
6887
6888 done:
6889 if (inev.ie.kind != NO_EVENT)
6890 {
6891 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
6892 count++;
6893 }
6894
6895 if (do_help
6896 && !(hold_quit && hold_quit->kind != NO_EVENT))
6897 {
6898 Lisp_Object frame;
6899
6900 if (f)
6901 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
6902 else
6903 frame = Qnil;
6904
6905 if (do_help > 0)
6906 {
6907 any_help_event_p = 1;
6908 gen_help_event (help_echo_string, frame, help_echo_window,
6909 help_echo_object, help_echo_pos);
6910 }
6911 else
6912 {
6913 help_echo_string = Qnil;
6914 gen_help_event (Qnil, frame, Qnil, Qnil, 0);
6915 }
6916 count++;
6917 }
6918
6919 *eventp = event;
6920 return count;
6921 }
6922
6923
6924 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DISPLAY.
6925 This is used for event loops outside the normal event handling,
6926 i.e. looping while a popup menu or a dialog is posted.
6927
6928 Returns the value handle_one_xevent sets in the finish argument. */
6929 int
6930 x_dispatch_event (event, display)
6931 XEvent *event;
6932 Display *display;
6933 {
6934 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
6935 int finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
6936
6937 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (display);
6938
6939 if (dpyinfo)
6940 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, event, &finish, 0);
6941
6942 return finish;
6943 }
6944
6945
6946 /* Read events coming from the X server.
6947 This routine is called by the SIGIO handler.
6948 We return as soon as there are no more events to be read.
6949
6950 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer,
6951 thus pretending to be `read'.
6952
6953 EXPECTED is nonzero if the caller knows input is available. */
6954
6955 static int
6956 XTread_socket (sd, expected, hold_quit)
6957 register int sd;
6958 int expected;
6959 struct input_event *hold_quit;
6960 {
6961 int count = 0;
6962 XEvent event;
6963 int event_found = 0;
6964 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
6965
6966 if (interrupt_input_blocked)
6967 {
6968 interrupt_input_pending = 1;
6969 return -1;
6970 }
6971
6972 interrupt_input_pending = 0;
6973 BLOCK_INPUT;
6974
6975 /* So people can tell when we have read the available input. */
6976 input_signal_count++;
6977
6978 ++handling_signal;
6979
6980 /* Find the display we are supposed to read input for.
6981 It's the one communicating on descriptor SD. */
6982 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
6983 {
6984 #if 0 /* This ought to be unnecessary; let's verify it. */
6985 #ifdef FIOSNBIO
6986 /* If available, Xlib uses FIOSNBIO to make the socket
6987 non-blocking, and then looks for EWOULDBLOCK. If O_NDELAY is set,
6988 FIOSNBIO is ignored, and instead of signaling EWOULDBLOCK,
6989 a read returns 0, which Xlib interprets as equivalent to EPIPE. */
6990 fcntl (dpyinfo->connection, F_SETFL, 0);
6991 #endif /* ! defined (FIOSNBIO) */
6992 #endif
6993
6994 #if 0 /* This code can't be made to work, with multiple displays,
6995 and appears not to be used on any system any more.
6996 Also keyboard.c doesn't turn O_NDELAY on and off
6997 for X connections. */
6998 #ifndef SIGIO
6999 #ifndef HAVE_SELECT
7000 if (! (fcntl (dpyinfo->connection, F_GETFL, 0) & O_NDELAY))
7001 {
7002 extern int read_alarm_should_throw;
7003 read_alarm_should_throw = 1;
7004 XPeekEvent (dpyinfo->display, &event);
7005 read_alarm_should_throw = 0;
7006 }
7007 #endif /* HAVE_SELECT */
7008 #endif /* SIGIO */
7009 #endif
7010
7011 /* For debugging, this gives a way to fake an I/O error. */
7012 if (dpyinfo == XTread_socket_fake_io_error)
7013 {
7014 XTread_socket_fake_io_error = 0;
7015 x_io_error_quitter (dpyinfo->display);
7016 }
7017
7018 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
7019 {
7020 struct input_event inev;
7021 BLOCK_INPUT;
7022 /* We don't need to EVENT_INIT (inev) here, as
7023 x_session_check_input copies an entire input_event. */
7024 if (x_session_check_input (&inev))
7025 {
7026 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev, hold_quit);
7027 count++;
7028 }
7029 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7030 }
7031 #endif
7032
7033 #ifndef USE_GTK
7034 while (XPending (dpyinfo->display))
7035 {
7036 int finish;
7037
7038 XNextEvent (dpyinfo->display, &event);
7039
7040 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7041 /* Filter events for the current X input method. */
7042 if (x_filter_event (dpyinfo, &event))
7043 break;
7044 #endif
7045 event_found = 1;
7046
7047 count += handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, &event, &finish, hold_quit);
7048
7049 if (finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7050 goto out;
7051 }
7052 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
7053 }
7054
7055 #ifdef USE_GTK
7056
7057 /* For GTK we must use the GTK event loop. But XEvents gets passed
7058 to our filter function above, and then to the big event switch.
7059 We use a bunch of globals to communicate with our filter function,
7060 that is kind of ugly, but it works.
7061
7062 There is no way to do one display at the time, GTK just does events
7063 from all displays. */
7064
7065 while (gtk_events_pending ())
7066 {
7067 current_count = count;
7068 current_hold_quit = hold_quit;
7069
7070 gtk_main_iteration ();
7071
7072 count = current_count;
7073 current_count = -1;
7074 current_hold_quit = 0;
7075
7076 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7077 break;
7078 }
7079 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7080
7081 out:;
7082
7083 /* On some systems, an X bug causes Emacs to get no more events
7084 when the window is destroyed. Detect that. (1994.) */
7085 if (! event_found)
7086 {
7087 /* Emacs and the X Server eats up CPU time if XNoOp is done every time.
7088 One XNOOP in 100 loops will make Emacs terminate.
7089 B. Bretthauer, 1994 */
7090 x_noop_count++;
7091 if (x_noop_count >= 100)
7092 {
7093 x_noop_count=0;
7094
7095 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == 0)
7096 next_noop_dpyinfo = x_display_list;
7097
7098 XNoOp (next_noop_dpyinfo->display);
7099
7100 /* Each time we get here, cycle through the displays now open. */
7101 next_noop_dpyinfo = next_noop_dpyinfo->next;
7102 }
7103 }
7104
7105 /* If the focus was just given to an auto-raising frame,
7106 raise it now. */
7107 /* ??? This ought to be able to handle more than one such frame. */
7108 if (pending_autoraise_frame)
7109 {
7110 x_raise_frame (pending_autoraise_frame);
7111 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
7112 }
7113
7114 --handling_signal;
7115 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7116
7117 return count;
7118 }
7119
7120
7121
7122 \f
7123 /***********************************************************************
7124 Text Cursor
7125 ***********************************************************************/
7126
7127 /* Set clipping for output in glyph row ROW. W is the window in which
7128 we operate. GC is the graphics context to set clipping in.
7129
7130 ROW may be a text row or, e.g., a mode line. Text rows must be
7131 clipped to the interior of the window dedicated to text display,
7132 mode lines must be clipped to the whole window. */
7133
7134 static void
7135 x_clip_to_row (w, row, area, gc)
7136 struct window *w;
7137 struct glyph_row *row;
7138 int area;
7139 GC gc;
7140 {
7141 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7142 XRectangle clip_rect;
7143 int window_x, window_y, window_width;
7144
7145 window_box (w, area, &window_x, &window_y, &window_width, 0);
7146
7147 clip_rect.x = window_x;
7148 clip_rect.y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, row->y));
7149 clip_rect.y = max (clip_rect.y, window_y);
7150 clip_rect.width = window_width;
7151 clip_rect.height = row->visible_height;
7152
7153 XSetClipRectangles (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc, 0, 0, &clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
7154 }
7155
7156
7157 /* Draw a hollow box cursor on window W in glyph row ROW. */
7158
7159 static void
7160 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, row)
7161 struct window *w;
7162 struct glyph_row *row;
7163 {
7164 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7165 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
7166 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7167 int x, y, wd, h;
7168 XGCValues xgcv;
7169 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7170 GC gc;
7171
7172 /* Get the glyph the cursor is on. If we can't tell because
7173 the current matrix is invalid or such, give up. */
7174 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7175 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7176 return;
7177
7178 /* Compute frame-relative coordinates for phys cursor. */
7179 x = WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x);
7180 y = get_phys_cursor_geometry (w, row, cursor_glyph, &h);
7181 wd = w->phys_cursor_width;
7182
7183 /* The foreground of cursor_gc is typically the same as the normal
7184 background color, which can cause the cursor box to be invisible. */
7185 xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7186 if (dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc)
7187 XChangeGC (dpy, dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
7188 else
7189 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7190 GCForeground, &xgcv);
7191 gc = dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc;
7192
7193 /* Set clipping, draw the rectangle, and reset clipping again. */
7194 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7195 XDrawRectangle (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc, x, y, wd, h);
7196 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7197 }
7198
7199
7200 /* Draw a bar cursor on window W in glyph row ROW.
7201
7202 Implementation note: One would like to draw a bar cursor with an
7203 angle equal to the one given by the font property XA_ITALIC_ANGLE.
7204 Unfortunately, I didn't find a font yet that has this property set.
7205 --gerd. */
7206
7207 static void
7208 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, row, width, kind)
7209 struct window *w;
7210 struct glyph_row *row;
7211 int width;
7212 enum text_cursor_kinds kind;
7213 {
7214 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
7215 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7216
7217 /* If cursor is out of bounds, don't draw garbage. This can happen
7218 in mini-buffer windows when switching between echo area glyphs
7219 and mini-buffer. */
7220 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7221 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7222 return;
7223
7224 /* If on an image, draw like a normal cursor. That's usually better
7225 visible than drawing a bar, esp. if the image is large so that
7226 the bar might not be in the window. */
7227 if (cursor_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
7228 {
7229 struct glyph_row *row;
7230 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->phys_cursor.vpos);
7231 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, row, DRAW_CURSOR);
7232 }
7233 else
7234 {
7235 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7236 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
7237 GC gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
7238 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
7239 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, cursor_glyph->face_id);
7240 XGCValues xgcv;
7241
7242 /* If the glyph's background equals the color we normally draw
7243 the bar cursor in, the bar cursor in its normal color is
7244 invisible. Use the glyph's foreground color instead in this
7245 case, on the assumption that the glyph's colors are chosen so
7246 that the glyph is legible. */
7247 if (face->background == f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
7248 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = face->foreground;
7249 else
7250 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7251 xgcv.graphics_exposures = 0;
7252
7253 if (gc)
7254 XChangeGC (dpy, gc, mask, &xgcv);
7255 else
7256 {
7257 gc = XCreateGC (dpy, window, mask, &xgcv);
7258 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc = gc;
7259 }
7260
7261 if (width < 0)
7262 width = FRAME_CURSOR_WIDTH (f);
7263 width = min (cursor_glyph->pixel_width, width);
7264
7265 w->phys_cursor_width = width;
7266 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7267
7268 if (kind == BAR_CURSOR)
7269 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc,
7270 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x),
7271 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y),
7272 width, row->height);
7273 else
7274 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc,
7275 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x),
7276 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y +
7277 row->height - width),
7278 cursor_glyph->pixel_width,
7279 width);
7280
7281 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7282 }
7283 }
7284
7285
7286 /* RIF: Define cursor CURSOR on frame F. */
7287
7288 static void
7289 x_define_frame_cursor (f, cursor)
7290 struct frame *f;
7291 Cursor cursor;
7292 {
7293 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), cursor);
7294 }
7295
7296
7297 /* RIF: Clear area on frame F. */
7298
7299 static void
7300 x_clear_frame_area (f, x, y, width, height)
7301 struct frame *f;
7302 int x, y, width, height;
7303 {
7304 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7305 x, y, width, height, False);
7306 }
7307
7308
7309 /* RIF: Draw cursor on window W. */
7310
7311 static void
7312 x_draw_window_cursor (w, glyph_row, x, y, cursor_type, cursor_width, on_p, active_p)
7313 struct window *w;
7314 struct glyph_row *glyph_row;
7315 int x, y;
7316 int cursor_type, cursor_width;
7317 int on_p, active_p;
7318 {
7319 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7320
7321 if (on_p)
7322 {
7323 w->phys_cursor_type = cursor_type;
7324 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 1;
7325
7326 if (glyph_row->exact_window_width_line_p
7327 && w->phys_cursor.hpos >= glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA])
7328 {
7329 glyph_row->cursor_in_fringe_p = 1;
7330 draw_fringe_bitmap (w, glyph_row, 0);
7331 }
7332 else
7333 switch (cursor_type)
7334 {
7335 case HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR:
7336 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, glyph_row);
7337 break;
7338
7339 case FILLED_BOX_CURSOR:
7340 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, glyph_row, DRAW_CURSOR);
7341 break;
7342
7343 case BAR_CURSOR:
7344 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, BAR_CURSOR);
7345 break;
7346
7347 case HBAR_CURSOR:
7348 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, HBAR_CURSOR);
7349 break;
7350
7351 case NO_CURSOR:
7352 w->phys_cursor_width = 0;
7353 break;
7354
7355 default:
7356 abort ();
7357 }
7358
7359 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7360 if (w == XWINDOW (f->selected_window))
7361 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition))
7362 xic_set_preeditarea (w, x, y);
7363 #endif
7364 }
7365
7366 #ifndef XFlush
7367 if (updating_frame != f)
7368 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
7369 #endif
7370 }
7371
7372 \f
7373 /* Icons. */
7374
7375 /* Make the x-window of frame F use the gnu icon bitmap. */
7376
7377 int
7378 x_bitmap_icon (f, file)
7379 struct frame *f;
7380 Lisp_Object file;
7381 {
7382 int bitmap_id;
7383
7384 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7385 return 1;
7386
7387 /* Free up our existing icon bitmap and mask if any. */
7388 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7389 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7390 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7391
7392 if (STRINGP (file))
7393 {
7394 #ifdef USE_GTK
7395 /* Use gtk_window_set_icon_from_file () if available,
7396 It's not restricted to bitmaps */
7397 if (xg_set_icon (f, file))
7398 return 0;
7399 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7400 bitmap_id = x_create_bitmap_from_file (f, file);
7401 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, bitmap_id);
7402 }
7403 else
7404 {
7405 /* Create the GNU bitmap and mask if necessary. */
7406 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id < 0)
7407 {
7408 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id
7409 = x_create_bitmap_from_data (f, gnu_bits,
7410 gnu_width, gnu_height);
7411 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7412 }
7413
7414 /* The first time we create the GNU bitmap and mask,
7415 this increments the ref-count one extra time.
7416 As a result, the GNU bitmap and mask are never freed.
7417 That way, we don't have to worry about allocating it again. */
7418 x_reference_bitmap (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7419
7420 bitmap_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id;
7421 }
7422
7423 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, bitmap_id);
7424 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = bitmap_id;
7425
7426 return 0;
7427 }
7428
7429
7430 /* Make the x-window of frame F use a rectangle with text.
7431 Use ICON_NAME as the text. */
7432
7433 int
7434 x_text_icon (f, icon_name)
7435 struct frame *f;
7436 char *icon_name;
7437 {
7438 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7439 return 1;
7440
7441 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
7442 {
7443 XTextProperty text;
7444 text.value = (unsigned char *) icon_name;
7445 text.encoding = XA_STRING;
7446 text.format = 8;
7447 text.nitems = strlen (icon_name);
7448 XSetWMIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &text);
7449 }
7450 #else /* not HAVE_X11R4 */
7451 XSetIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), icon_name);
7452 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R4 */
7453
7454 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7455 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7456 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7457 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, 0);
7458
7459 return 0;
7460 }
7461 \f
7462 #define X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE 200
7463
7464 /* If non-nil, this should be a string.
7465 It means catch X errors and store the error message in this string. */
7466
7467 static Lisp_Object x_error_message_string;
7468
7469 /* An X error handler which stores the error message in
7470 x_error_message_string. This is called from x_error_handler if
7471 x_catch_errors is in effect. */
7472
7473 static void
7474 x_error_catcher (display, error)
7475 Display *display;
7476 XErrorEvent *error;
7477 {
7478 XGetErrorText (display, error->error_code,
7479 SDATA (x_error_message_string),
7480 X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7481 }
7482
7483 /* Begin trapping X errors for display DPY. Actually we trap X errors
7484 for all displays, but DPY should be the display you are actually
7485 operating on.
7486
7487 After calling this function, X protocol errors no longer cause
7488 Emacs to exit; instead, they are recorded in the string
7489 stored in x_error_message_string.
7490
7491 Calling x_check_errors signals an Emacs error if an X error has
7492 occurred since the last call to x_catch_errors or x_check_errors.
7493
7494 Calling x_uncatch_errors resumes the normal error handling. */
7495
7496 void x_check_errors ();
7497 static Lisp_Object x_catch_errors_unwind ();
7498
7499 int
7500 x_catch_errors (dpy)
7501 Display *dpy;
7502 {
7503 int count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
7504
7505 /* Make sure any errors from previous requests have been dealt with. */
7506 XSync (dpy, False);
7507
7508 record_unwind_protect (x_catch_errors_unwind,
7509 Fcons (make_save_value (dpy, 0),
7510 x_error_message_string));
7511
7512 x_error_message_string = make_uninit_string (X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7513 SSET (x_error_message_string, 0, 0);
7514
7515 return count;
7516 }
7517
7518 /* Unbind the binding that we made to check for X errors. */
7519
7520 static Lisp_Object
7521 x_catch_errors_unwind (old_val)
7522 Lisp_Object old_val;
7523 {
7524 Lisp_Object first = XCAR (old_val);
7525 Display *dpy = XSAVE_VALUE (first)->pointer;
7526
7527 /* The display may have been closed before this function is called.
7528 Check if it is still open before calling XSync. */
7529 if (x_display_info_for_display (dpy) != 0)
7530 {
7531 BLOCK_INPUT;
7532 XSync (dpy, False);
7533 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7534 }
7535
7536 x_error_message_string = XCDR (old_val);
7537 return Qnil;
7538 }
7539
7540 /* If any X protocol errors have arrived since the last call to
7541 x_catch_errors or x_check_errors, signal an Emacs error using
7542 sprintf (a buffer, FORMAT, the x error message text) as the text. */
7543
7544 void
7545 x_check_errors (dpy, format)
7546 Display *dpy;
7547 char *format;
7548 {
7549 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7550 XSync (dpy, False);
7551
7552 if (SREF (x_error_message_string, 0))
7553 error (format, SDATA (x_error_message_string));
7554 }
7555
7556 /* Nonzero if we had any X protocol errors
7557 since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7558
7559 int
7560 x_had_errors_p (dpy)
7561 Display *dpy;
7562 {
7563 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7564 XSync (dpy, False);
7565
7566 return SREF (x_error_message_string, 0) != 0;
7567 }
7568
7569 /* Forget about any errors we have had, since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7570
7571 void
7572 x_clear_errors (dpy)
7573 Display *dpy;
7574 {
7575 SSET (x_error_message_string, 0, 0);
7576 }
7577
7578 /* Stop catching X protocol errors and let them make Emacs die.
7579 DPY should be the display that was passed to x_catch_errors.
7580 COUNT should be the value that was returned by
7581 the corresponding call to x_catch_errors. */
7582
7583 void
7584 x_uncatch_errors (dpy, count)
7585 Display *dpy;
7586 int count;
7587 {
7588 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
7589 }
7590
7591 #if 0
7592 static unsigned int x_wire_count;
7593 x_trace_wire ()
7594 {
7595 fprintf (stderr, "Lib call: %d\n", ++x_wire_count);
7596 }
7597 #endif /* ! 0 */
7598
7599 \f
7600 /* Handle SIGPIPE, which can happen when the connection to a server
7601 simply goes away. SIGPIPE is handled by x_connection_signal.
7602 Don't need to do anything, because the write which caused the
7603 SIGPIPE will fail, causing Xlib to invoke the X IO error handler,
7604 which will do the appropriate cleanup for us. */
7605
7606 static SIGTYPE
7607 x_connection_signal (signalnum) /* If we don't have an argument, */
7608 int signalnum; /* some compilers complain in signal calls. */
7609 {
7610 #ifdef USG
7611 /* USG systems forget handlers when they are used;
7612 must reestablish each time */
7613 signal (signalnum, x_connection_signal);
7614 #endif /* USG */
7615 }
7616
7617 \f
7618 /************************************************************************
7619 Handling X errors
7620 ************************************************************************/
7621
7622 /* Error message passed to x_connection_closed. */
7623
7624 static char *error_msg;
7625
7626 /* Function installed as fatal_error_signal_hook in
7627 x_connection_closed. Print the X error message, and exit normally,
7628 instead of dumping core when XtCloseDisplay fails. */
7629
7630 static void
7631 x_fatal_error_signal ()
7632 {
7633 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
7634 exit (70);
7635 }
7636
7637 /* Handle the loss of connection to display DPY. ERROR_MESSAGE is
7638 the text of an error message that lead to the connection loss. */
7639
7640 static SIGTYPE
7641 x_connection_closed (dpy, error_message)
7642 Display *dpy;
7643 char *error_message;
7644 {
7645 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
7646 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7647 int count;
7648
7649 error_msg = (char *) alloca (strlen (error_message) + 1);
7650 strcpy (error_msg, error_message);
7651 handling_signal = 0;
7652
7653 /* Prevent being called recursively because of an error condition
7654 below. Otherwise, we might end up with printing ``can't find per
7655 display information'' in the recursive call instead of printing
7656 the original message here. */
7657 count = x_catch_errors (dpy);
7658
7659 /* We have to close the display to inform Xt that it doesn't
7660 exist anymore. If we don't, Xt will continue to wait for
7661 events from the display. As a consequence, a sequence of
7662
7663 M-x make-frame-on-display RET :1 RET
7664 ...kill the new frame, so that we get an IO error...
7665 M-x make-frame-on-display RET :1 RET
7666
7667 will indefinitely wait in Xt for events for display `:1', opened
7668 in the first class to make-frame-on-display.
7669
7670 Closing the display is reported to lead to a bus error on
7671 OpenWindows in certain situations. I suspect that is a bug
7672 in OpenWindows. I don't know how to cicumvent it here. */
7673
7674 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
7675 /* If DPYINFO is null, this means we didn't open the display
7676 in the first place, so don't try to close it. */
7677 if (dpyinfo)
7678 {
7679 extern void (*fatal_error_signal_hook) P_ ((void));
7680 fatal_error_signal_hook = x_fatal_error_signal;
7681 XtCloseDisplay (dpy);
7682 fatal_error_signal_hook = NULL;
7683 }
7684 #endif
7685
7686 #ifdef USE_GTK
7687 if (dpyinfo)
7688 xg_display_close (dpyinfo->display);
7689 #endif
7690
7691 /* Indicate that this display is dead. */
7692 if (dpyinfo)
7693 dpyinfo->display = 0;
7694
7695 /* First delete frames whose mini-buffers are on frames
7696 that are on the dead display. */
7697 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7698 {
7699 Lisp_Object minibuf_frame;
7700 minibuf_frame
7701 = WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (XFRAME (frame))));
7702 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7703 && FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (minibuf_frame))
7704 && ! EQ (frame, minibuf_frame)
7705 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (minibuf_frame)) == dpyinfo)
7706 Fdelete_frame (frame, Qt);
7707 }
7708
7709 /* Now delete all remaining frames on the dead display.
7710 We are now sure none of these is used as the mini-buffer
7711 for another frame that we need to delete. */
7712 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7713 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7714 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame)) == dpyinfo)
7715 {
7716 /* Set this to t so that Fdelete_frame won't get confused
7717 trying to find a replacement. */
7718 FRAME_KBOARD (XFRAME (frame))->Vdefault_minibuffer_frame = Qt;
7719 Fdelete_frame (frame, Qt);
7720 }
7721
7722 if (dpyinfo)
7723 x_delete_display (dpyinfo);
7724
7725 x_uncatch_errors (dpy, count);
7726
7727 if (x_display_list == 0)
7728 {
7729 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
7730 shut_down_emacs (0, 0, Qnil);
7731 exit (70);
7732 }
7733
7734 /* Ordinary stack unwind doesn't deal with these. */
7735 #ifdef SIGIO
7736 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGIO));
7737 #endif
7738 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGALRM));
7739 TOTALLY_UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7740
7741 clear_waiting_for_input ();
7742 error ("%s", error_msg);
7743 }
7744
7745 /* We specifically use it before defining it, so that gcc doesn't inline it,
7746 otherwise gdb doesn't know how to properly put a breakpoint on it. */
7747 static void x_error_quitter (Display *display, XErrorEvent *error);
7748
7749 /* This is the first-level handler for X protocol errors.
7750 It calls x_error_quitter or x_error_catcher. */
7751
7752 static int
7753 x_error_handler (display, error)
7754 Display *display;
7755 XErrorEvent *error;
7756 {
7757 if (! NILP (x_error_message_string))
7758 x_error_catcher (display, error);
7759 else
7760 x_error_quitter (display, error);
7761 return 0;
7762 }
7763
7764 /* This is the usual handler for X protocol errors.
7765 It kills all frames on the display that we got the error for.
7766 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7767
7768 /* .gdbinit puts a breakpoint here, so make sure it is not inlined. */
7769
7770 #if __GNUC__ >= 3 /* On GCC 3.0 we might get a warning. */
7771 #define NO_INLINE __attribute__((noinline))
7772 #else
7773 #define NO_INLINE
7774 #endif
7775
7776 /* Some versions of GNU/Linux define noinline in their headers. */
7777
7778 #ifdef noinline
7779 #undef noinline
7780 #endif
7781
7782 /* On older GCC versions, just putting x_error_quitter
7783 after x_error_handler prevents inlining into the former. */
7784
7785 static void NO_INLINE
7786 x_error_quitter (display, error)
7787 Display *display;
7788 XErrorEvent *error;
7789 {
7790 char buf[256], buf1[356];
7791
7792 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
7793 original error handler. */
7794
7795 XGetErrorText (display, error->error_code, buf, sizeof (buf));
7796 sprintf (buf1, "X protocol error: %s on protocol request %d",
7797 buf, error->request_code);
7798 x_connection_closed (display, buf1);
7799 }
7800
7801
7802 /* This is the handler for X IO errors, always.
7803 It kills all frames on the display that we lost touch with.
7804 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7805
7806 static int
7807 x_io_error_quitter (display)
7808 Display *display;
7809 {
7810 char buf[256];
7811
7812 sprintf (buf, "Connection lost to X server `%s'", DisplayString (display));
7813 x_connection_closed (display, buf);
7814 return 0;
7815 }
7816 \f
7817 /* Changing the font of the frame. */
7818
7819 /* Give frame F the font named FONTNAME as its default font, and
7820 return the full name of that font. FONTNAME may be a wildcard
7821 pattern; in that case, we choose some font that fits the pattern.
7822 The return value shows which font we chose. */
7823
7824 Lisp_Object
7825 x_new_font (f, fontname)
7826 struct frame *f;
7827 register char *fontname;
7828 {
7829 struct font_info *fontp
7830 = FS_LOAD_FONT (f, 0, fontname, -1);
7831
7832 if (!fontp)
7833 return Qnil;
7834
7835 FRAME_FONT (f) = (XFontStruct *) (fontp->font);
7836 FRAME_BASELINE_OFFSET (f) = fontp->baseline_offset;
7837 FRAME_FONTSET (f) = -1;
7838
7839 FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) = fontp->average_width;
7840 FRAME_SPACE_WIDTH (f) = fontp->space_width;
7841 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) = FONT_HEIGHT (FRAME_FONT (f));
7842
7843 compute_fringe_widths (f, 1);
7844
7845 /* Compute the scroll bar width in character columns. */
7846 if (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) > 0)
7847 {
7848 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7849 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f)
7850 = (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) + wid-1) / wid;
7851 }
7852 else
7853 {
7854 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7855 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) = (14 + wid - 1) / wid;
7856 }
7857
7858 /* Now make the frame display the given font. */
7859 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) != 0)
7860 {
7861 XSetFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
7862 FRAME_FONT (f)->fid);
7863 XSetFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->reverse_gc,
7864 FRAME_FONT (f)->fid);
7865 XSetFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->cursor_gc,
7866 FRAME_FONT (f)->fid);
7867
7868 /* Don't change the size of a tip frame; there's no point in
7869 doing it because it's done in Fx_show_tip, and it leads to
7870 problems because the tip frame has no widget. */
7871 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
7872 x_set_window_size (f, 0, FRAME_COLS (f), FRAME_LINES (f));
7873 }
7874
7875 return build_string (fontp->full_name);
7876 }
7877
7878 /* Give frame F the fontset named FONTSETNAME as its default font, and
7879 return the full name of that fontset. FONTSETNAME may be a wildcard
7880 pattern; in that case, we choose some fontset that fits the pattern.
7881 The return value shows which fontset we chose. */
7882
7883 Lisp_Object
7884 x_new_fontset (f, fontsetname)
7885 struct frame *f;
7886 char *fontsetname;
7887 {
7888 int fontset = fs_query_fontset (build_string (fontsetname), 0);
7889 Lisp_Object result;
7890
7891 if (fontset < 0)
7892 return Qnil;
7893
7894 if (FRAME_FONTSET (f) == fontset)
7895 /* This fontset is already set in frame F. There's nothing more
7896 to do. */
7897 return fontset_name (fontset);
7898
7899 result = x_new_font (f, (SDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset))));
7900
7901 if (!STRINGP (result))
7902 /* Can't load ASCII font. */
7903 return Qnil;
7904
7905 /* Since x_new_font doesn't update any fontset information, do it now. */
7906 FRAME_FONTSET (f) = fontset;
7907
7908 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7909 if (FRAME_XIC (f)
7910 && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & (XIMPreeditPosition | XIMStatusArea)))
7911 xic_set_xfontset (f, SDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset)));
7912 #endif
7913
7914 return build_string (fontsetname);
7915 }
7916
7917 \f
7918 /***********************************************************************
7919 X Input Methods
7920 ***********************************************************************/
7921
7922 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7923
7924 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7925
7926 /* XIM destroy callback function, which is called whenever the
7927 connection to input method XIM dies. CLIENT_DATA contains a
7928 pointer to the x_display_info structure corresponding to XIM. */
7929
7930 static void
7931 xim_destroy_callback (xim, client_data, call_data)
7932 XIM xim;
7933 XPointer client_data;
7934 XPointer call_data;
7935 {
7936 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) client_data;
7937 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7938
7939 BLOCK_INPUT;
7940
7941 /* No need to call XDestroyIC.. */
7942 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7943 {
7944 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
7945 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo)
7946 {
7947 FRAME_XIC (f) = NULL;
7948 xic_free_xfontset (f);
7949 }
7950 }
7951
7952 /* No need to call XCloseIM. */
7953 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
7954 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
7955 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7956 }
7957
7958 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6 */
7959
7960 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7961 /* This isn't prototyped in OSF 5.0 or 5.1a. */
7962 extern char *XSetIMValues P_ ((XIM, ...));
7963 #endif
7964
7965 /* Open the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
7966 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name Emacs uses. */
7967
7968 static void
7969 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name)
7970 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
7971 char *resource_name;
7972 {
7973 XIM xim;
7974
7975 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
7976 if (use_xim)
7977 {
7978 xim = XOpenIM (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb, resource_name,
7979 EMACS_CLASS);
7980 dpyinfo->xim = xim;
7981
7982 if (xim)
7983 {
7984 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7985 XIMCallback destroy;
7986 #endif
7987
7988 /* Get supported styles and XIM values. */
7989 XGetIMValues (xim, XNQueryInputStyle, &dpyinfo->xim_styles, NULL);
7990
7991 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7992 destroy.callback = xim_destroy_callback;
7993 destroy.client_data = (XPointer)dpyinfo;
7994 XSetIMValues (xim, XNDestroyCallback, &destroy, NULL);
7995 #endif
7996 }
7997 }
7998
7999 else
8000 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8001 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8002 }
8003
8004
8005 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8006
8007 struct xim_inst_t
8008 {
8009 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
8010 char *resource_name;
8011 };
8012
8013 /* XIM instantiate callback function, which is called whenever an XIM
8014 server is available. DISPLAY is the display of the XIM.
8015 CLIENT_DATA contains a pointer to an xim_inst_t structure created
8016 when the callback was registered. */
8017
8018 static void
8019 xim_instantiate_callback (display, client_data, call_data)
8020 Display *display;
8021 XPointer client_data;
8022 XPointer call_data;
8023 {
8024 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) client_data;
8025 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = xim_inst->dpyinfo;
8026
8027 /* We don't support multiple XIM connections. */
8028 if (dpyinfo->xim)
8029 return;
8030
8031 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, xim_inst->resource_name);
8032
8033 /* Create XIC for the existing frames on the same display, as long
8034 as they have no XIC. */
8035 if (dpyinfo->xim && dpyinfo->reference_count > 0)
8036 {
8037 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
8038
8039 BLOCK_INPUT;
8040 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
8041 {
8042 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
8043
8044 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == xim_inst->dpyinfo)
8045 if (FRAME_XIC (f) == NULL)
8046 {
8047 create_frame_xic (f);
8048 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea)
8049 xic_set_statusarea (f);
8050 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition)
8051 {
8052 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->selected_window);
8053 xic_set_preeditarea (w, w->cursor.x, w->cursor.y);
8054 }
8055 }
8056 }
8057
8058 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8059 }
8060 }
8061
8062 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8063
8064
8065 /* Open a connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8066 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name for Emacs. On X11R5, open the
8067 connection only at the first time. On X11R6, open the connection
8068 in the XIM instantiate callback function. */
8069
8070 static void
8071 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name)
8072 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
8073 char *resource_name;
8074 {
8075 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8076 if (use_xim)
8077 {
8078 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8079 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst;
8080 int len;
8081
8082 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8083 xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct xim_inst_t));
8084 xim_inst->dpyinfo = dpyinfo;
8085 len = strlen (resource_name);
8086 xim_inst->resource_name = (char *) xmalloc (len + 1);
8087 bcopy (resource_name, xim_inst->resource_name, len + 1);
8088 XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8089 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
8090 xim_instantiate_callback,
8091 /* This is XPointer in XFree86
8092 but (XPointer *) on Tru64, at
8093 least, hence the configure test. */
8094 (XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback_arg6) xim_inst);
8095 #else /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8096 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8097 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name);
8098 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8099
8100 }
8101 else
8102 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8103 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8104 }
8105
8106
8107 /* Close the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO. */
8108
8109 static void
8110 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo)
8111 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
8112 {
8113 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8114 if (use_xim)
8115 {
8116 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8117 if (dpyinfo->display)
8118 XUnregisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8119 NULL, EMACS_CLASS,
8120 xim_instantiate_callback, NULL);
8121 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8122 if (dpyinfo->display)
8123 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
8124 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8125 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
8126 }
8127 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8128 }
8129
8130 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8131
8132
8133 \f
8134 /* Calculate the absolute position in frame F
8135 from its current recorded position values and gravity. */
8136
8137 void
8138 x_calc_absolute_position (f)
8139 struct frame *f;
8140 {
8141 int win_x = 0, win_y = 0;
8142 int flags = f->size_hint_flags;
8143
8144 /* We have nothing to do if the current position
8145 is already for the top-left corner. */
8146 if (! ((flags & XNegative) || (flags & YNegative)))
8147 return;
8148
8149 /* Treat negative positions as relative to the leftmost bottommost
8150 position that fits on the screen. */
8151 if (flags & XNegative)
8152 f->left_pos = (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->width
8153 - FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) + f->left_pos);
8154
8155 {
8156 int height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8157
8158 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && defined USE_MOTIF
8159 /* Something is fishy here. When using Motif, starting Emacs with
8160 `-g -0-0', the frame appears too low by a few pixels.
8161
8162 This seems to be so because initially, while Emacs is starting,
8163 the column widget's height and the frame's pixel height are
8164 different. The column widget's height is the right one. In
8165 later invocations, when Emacs is up, the frame's pixel height
8166 is right, though.
8167
8168 It's not obvious where the initial small difference comes from.
8169 2000-12-01, gerd. */
8170
8171 XtVaGetValues (f->output_data.x->column_widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
8172 #endif
8173
8174 if (flags & YNegative)
8175 f->top_pos = (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->height - height + f->top_pos);
8176 }
8177
8178 /* The left_pos and top_pos
8179 are now relative to the top and left screen edges,
8180 so the flags should correspond. */
8181 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8182 }
8183
8184 /* CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1 when calling from Fset_frame_position,
8185 to really change the position, and 0 when calling from
8186 x_make_frame_visible (in that case, XOFF and YOFF are the current
8187 position values). It is -1 when calling from x_set_frame_parameters,
8188 which means, do adjust for borders but don't change the gravity. */
8189
8190 void
8191 x_set_offset (f, xoff, yoff, change_gravity)
8192 struct frame *f;
8193 register int xoff, yoff;
8194 int change_gravity;
8195 {
8196 int modified_top, modified_left;
8197
8198 if (change_gravity > 0)
8199 {
8200 f->top_pos = yoff;
8201 f->left_pos = xoff;
8202 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8203 if (xoff < 0)
8204 f->size_hint_flags |= XNegative;
8205 if (yoff < 0)
8206 f->size_hint_flags |= YNegative;
8207 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8208 }
8209 x_calc_absolute_position (f);
8210
8211 BLOCK_INPUT;
8212 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8213
8214 modified_left = f->left_pos;
8215 modified_top = f->top_pos;
8216
8217 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A)
8218 {
8219 /* Some WMs (twm, wmaker at least) has an offset that is smaller
8220 than the WM decorations. So we use the calculated offset instead
8221 of the WM decoration sizes here (x/y_pixels_outer_diff). */
8222 modified_left += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8223 modified_top += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8224 }
8225
8226 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8227 modified_left, modified_top);
8228
8229 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
8230 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN)
8231 {
8232 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->check_expected_move = 1;
8233 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->expected_top = f->top_pos;
8234 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->expected_left = f->left_pos;
8235 }
8236
8237 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8238 }
8239
8240 /* Check if we need to resize the frame due to a fullscreen request.
8241 If so needed, resize the frame. */
8242 static void
8243 x_check_fullscreen (f)
8244 struct frame *f;
8245 {
8246 if (f->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
8247 {
8248 int width, height, ign;
8249
8250 x_real_positions (f, &f->left_pos, &f->top_pos);
8251
8252 x_fullscreen_adjust (f, &width, &height, &ign, &ign);
8253
8254 /* We do not need to move the window, it shall be taken care of
8255 when setting WM manager hints.
8256 If the frame is visible already, the position is checked by
8257 x_check_expected_move. */
8258 if (FRAME_COLS (f) != width || FRAME_LINES (f) != height)
8259 {
8260 change_frame_size (f, height, width, 0, 1, 0);
8261 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
8262 cancel_mouse_face (f);
8263
8264 /* Wait for the change of frame size to occur */
8265 f->want_fullscreen |= FULLSCREEN_WAIT;
8266 }
8267 }
8268 }
8269
8270 /* If frame parameters are set after the frame is mapped, we need to move
8271 the window.
8272 Some window managers moves the window to the right position, some
8273 moves the outer window manager window to the specified position.
8274 Here we check that we are in the right spot. If not, make a second
8275 move, assuming we are dealing with the second kind of window manager. */
8276 static void
8277 x_check_expected_move (f)
8278 struct frame *f;
8279 {
8280 if (FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->check_expected_move)
8281 {
8282 int expect_top = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->expected_top;
8283 int expect_left = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->expected_left;
8284
8285 if (expect_top != f->top_pos || expect_left != f->left_pos)
8286 {
8287 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_A;
8288 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left = expect_left - f->left_pos;
8289 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top = expect_top - f->top_pos;
8290
8291 f->left_pos = expect_left;
8292 f->top_pos = expect_top;
8293 x_set_offset (f, expect_left, expect_top, 0);
8294 }
8295 else if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN)
8296 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_B;
8297
8298 /* Just do this once */
8299 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->check_expected_move = 0;
8300 }
8301 }
8302
8303
8304 /* Change the size of frame F's X window to COLS/ROWS in the case F
8305 doesn't have a widget. If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to
8306 top-left-corner window gravity for this size change and subsequent
8307 size changes. Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8308
8309 static void
8310 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows)
8311 struct frame *f;
8312 int change_gravity;
8313 int cols, rows;
8314 {
8315 int pixelwidth, pixelheight;
8316
8317 check_frame_size (f, &rows, &cols);
8318 f->scroll_bar_actual_width
8319 = (!FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f)
8320 ? 0
8321 : FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) > 0
8322 ? FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f)
8323 : (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f)));
8324
8325 compute_fringe_widths (f, 0);
8326
8327 pixelwidth = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, cols);
8328 pixelheight = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, rows);
8329
8330 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8331 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8332
8333 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
8334 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8335 pixelwidth, pixelheight);
8336
8337 /* Now, strictly speaking, we can't be sure that this is accurate,
8338 but the window manager will get around to dealing with the size
8339 change request eventually, and we'll hear how it went when the
8340 ConfigureNotify event gets here.
8341
8342 We could just not bother storing any of this information here,
8343 and let the ConfigureNotify event set everything up, but that
8344 might be kind of confusing to the Lisp code, since size changes
8345 wouldn't be reported in the frame parameters until some random
8346 point in the future when the ConfigureNotify event arrives.
8347
8348 We pass 1 for DELAY since we can't run Lisp code inside of
8349 a BLOCK_INPUT. */
8350 change_frame_size (f, rows, cols, 0, 1, 0);
8351 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = pixelwidth;
8352 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = pixelheight;
8353
8354 /* We've set {FRAME,PIXEL}_{WIDTH,HEIGHT} to the values we hope to
8355 receive in the ConfigureNotify event; if we get what we asked
8356 for, then the event won't cause the screen to become garbaged, so
8357 we have to make sure to do it here. */
8358 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
8359
8360 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8361 }
8362
8363
8364 /* Call this to change the size of frame F's x-window.
8365 If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to top-left-corner window gravity
8366 for this size change and subsequent size changes.
8367 Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8368
8369 void
8370 x_set_window_size (f, change_gravity, cols, rows)
8371 struct frame *f;
8372 int change_gravity;
8373 int cols, rows;
8374 {
8375 BLOCK_INPUT;
8376
8377 #ifdef USE_GTK
8378 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
8379 xg_frame_set_char_size (f, cols, rows);
8380 else
8381 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8382 #elif USE_X_TOOLKIT
8383
8384 if (f->output_data.x->widget != NULL)
8385 {
8386 /* The x and y position of the widget is clobbered by the
8387 call to XtSetValues within EmacsFrameSetCharSize.
8388 This is a real kludge, but I don't understand Xt so I can't
8389 figure out a correct fix. Can anyone else tell me? -- rms. */
8390 int xpos = f->output_data.x->widget->core.x;
8391 int ypos = f->output_data.x->widget->core.y;
8392 EmacsFrameSetCharSize (f->output_data.x->edit_widget, cols, rows);
8393 f->output_data.x->widget->core.x = xpos;
8394 f->output_data.x->widget->core.y = ypos;
8395 }
8396 else
8397 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8398
8399 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8400
8401 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8402
8403 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8404
8405 /* If cursor was outside the new size, mark it as off. */
8406 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (f->root_window));
8407
8408 /* Clear out any recollection of where the mouse highlighting was,
8409 since it might be in a place that's outside the new frame size.
8410 Actually checking whether it is outside is a pain in the neck,
8411 so don't try--just let the highlighting be done afresh with new size. */
8412 cancel_mouse_face (f);
8413
8414 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8415 }
8416 \f
8417 /* Mouse warping. */
8418
8419 void
8420 x_set_mouse_position (f, x, y)
8421 struct frame *f;
8422 int x, y;
8423 {
8424 int pix_x, pix_y;
8425
8426 pix_x = FRAME_COL_TO_PIXEL_X (f, x) + FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) / 2;
8427 pix_y = FRAME_LINE_TO_PIXEL_Y (f, y) + FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) / 2;
8428
8429 if (pix_x < 0) pix_x = 0;
8430 if (pix_x > FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)) pix_x = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
8431
8432 if (pix_y < 0) pix_y = 0;
8433 if (pix_y > FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f)) pix_y = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8434
8435 BLOCK_INPUT;
8436
8437 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8438 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8439 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8440 }
8441
8442 /* Move the mouse to position pixel PIX_X, PIX_Y relative to frame F. */
8443
8444 void
8445 x_set_mouse_pixel_position (f, pix_x, pix_y)
8446 struct frame *f;
8447 int pix_x, pix_y;
8448 {
8449 BLOCK_INPUT;
8450
8451 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8452 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8453 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8454 }
8455 \f
8456 /* focus shifting, raising and lowering. */
8457
8458 void
8459 x_focus_on_frame (f)
8460 struct frame *f;
8461 {
8462 #if 0 /* This proves to be unpleasant. */
8463 x_raise_frame (f);
8464 #endif
8465 #if 0
8466 /* I don't think that the ICCCM allows programs to do things like this
8467 without the interaction of the window manager. Whatever you end up
8468 doing with this code, do it to x_unfocus_frame too. */
8469 XSetInputFocus (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8470 RevertToPointerRoot, CurrentTime);
8471 #endif /* ! 0 */
8472 }
8473
8474 void
8475 x_unfocus_frame (f)
8476 struct frame *f;
8477 {
8478 #if 0
8479 /* Look at the remarks in x_focus_on_frame. */
8480 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_focus_frame == f)
8481 XSetInputFocus (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), PointerRoot,
8482 RevertToPointerRoot, CurrentTime);
8483 #endif /* ! 0 */
8484 }
8485
8486 /* Raise frame F. */
8487
8488 void
8489 x_raise_frame (f)
8490 struct frame *f;
8491 {
8492 if (f->async_visible)
8493 {
8494 BLOCK_INPUT;
8495 XRaiseWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8496 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8497 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8498 }
8499 }
8500
8501 /* Lower frame F. */
8502
8503 void
8504 x_lower_frame (f)
8505 struct frame *f;
8506 {
8507 if (f->async_visible)
8508 {
8509 BLOCK_INPUT;
8510 XLowerWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8511 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8512 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8513 }
8514 }
8515
8516 static void
8517 XTframe_raise_lower (f, raise_flag)
8518 FRAME_PTR f;
8519 int raise_flag;
8520 {
8521 if (raise_flag)
8522 x_raise_frame (f);
8523 else
8524 x_lower_frame (f);
8525 }
8526 \f
8527 /* Change of visibility. */
8528
8529 /* This tries to wait until the frame is really visible.
8530 However, if the window manager asks the user where to position
8531 the frame, this will return before the user finishes doing that.
8532 The frame will not actually be visible at that time,
8533 but it will become visible later when the window manager
8534 finishes with it. */
8535
8536 void
8537 x_make_frame_visible (f)
8538 struct frame *f;
8539 {
8540 Lisp_Object type;
8541 int original_top, original_left;
8542 int retry_count = 2;
8543
8544 retry:
8545
8546 BLOCK_INPUT;
8547
8548 type = x_icon_type (f);
8549 if (!NILP (type))
8550 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
8551
8552 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8553 {
8554 /* We test FRAME_GARBAGED_P here to make sure we don't
8555 call x_set_offset a second time
8556 if we get to x_make_frame_visible a second time
8557 before the window gets really visible. */
8558 if (! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
8559 && ! f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible)
8560 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
8561
8562 f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible = 1;
8563
8564 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
8565 x_wm_set_window_state (f, NormalState);
8566 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8567 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
8568 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
8569 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8570 #ifdef USE_GTK
8571 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
8572 gtk_window_deiconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
8573 #else
8574 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
8575 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
8576 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8577 #if 0 /* This seems to bring back scroll bars in the wrong places
8578 if the window configuration has changed. They seem
8579 to come back ok without this. */
8580 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
8581 XMapSubwindows (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
8582 #endif
8583 }
8584
8585 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8586
8587 /* Synchronize to ensure Emacs knows the frame is visible
8588 before we do anything else. We do this loop with input not blocked
8589 so that incoming events are handled. */
8590 {
8591 Lisp_Object frame;
8592 int count;
8593 /* This must be before UNBLOCK_INPUT
8594 since events that arrive in response to the actions above
8595 will set it when they are handled. */
8596 int previously_visible = f->output_data.x->has_been_visible;
8597
8598 original_left = f->left_pos;
8599 original_top = f->top_pos;
8600
8601 /* This must come after we set COUNT. */
8602 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8603
8604 /* We unblock here so that arriving X events are processed. */
8605
8606 /* Now move the window back to where it was "supposed to be".
8607 But don't do it if the gravity is negative.
8608 When the gravity is negative, this uses a position
8609 that is 3 pixels too low. Perhaps that's really the border width.
8610
8611 Don't do this if the window has never been visible before,
8612 because the window manager may choose the position
8613 and we don't want to override it. */
8614
8615 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
8616 && f->win_gravity == NorthWestGravity
8617 && previously_visible)
8618 {
8619 Drawable rootw;
8620 int x, y;
8621 unsigned int width, height, border, depth;
8622
8623 BLOCK_INPUT;
8624
8625 /* On some window managers (such as FVWM) moving an existing
8626 window, even to the same place, causes the window manager
8627 to introduce an offset. This can cause the window to move
8628 to an unexpected location. Check the geometry (a little
8629 slow here) and then verify that the window is in the right
8630 place. If the window is not in the right place, move it
8631 there, and take the potential window manager hit. */
8632 XGetGeometry (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8633 &rootw, &x, &y, &width, &height, &border, &depth);
8634
8635 if (original_left != x || original_top != y)
8636 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8637 original_left, original_top);
8638
8639 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8640 }
8641
8642 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8643
8644 /* Wait until the frame is visible. Process X events until a
8645 MapNotify event has been seen, or until we think we won't get a
8646 MapNotify at all.. */
8647 for (count = input_signal_count + 10;
8648 input_signal_count < count && !FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f);)
8649 {
8650 /* Force processing of queued events. */
8651 x_sync (f);
8652
8653 /* Machines that do polling rather than SIGIO have been
8654 observed to go into a busy-wait here. So we'll fake an
8655 alarm signal to let the handler know that there's something
8656 to be read. We used to raise a real alarm, but it seems
8657 that the handler isn't always enabled here. This is
8658 probably a bug. */
8659 if (input_polling_used ())
8660 {
8661 /* It could be confusing if a real alarm arrives while
8662 processing the fake one. Turn it off and let the
8663 handler reset it. */
8664 extern void poll_for_input_1 P_ ((void));
8665 int old_poll_suppress_count = poll_suppress_count;
8666 poll_suppress_count = 1;
8667 poll_for_input_1 ();
8668 poll_suppress_count = old_poll_suppress_count;
8669 }
8670
8671 /* See if a MapNotify event has been processed. */
8672 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
8673 }
8674
8675 /* 2000-09-28: In
8676
8677 (let ((f (selected-frame)))
8678 (iconify-frame f)
8679 (raise-frame f))
8680
8681 the frame is not raised with various window managers on
8682 FreeBSD, GNU/Linux and Solaris. It turns out that, for some
8683 unknown reason, the call to XtMapWidget is completely ignored.
8684 Mapping the widget a second time works. */
8685
8686 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && --retry_count > 0)
8687 goto retry;
8688 }
8689 }
8690
8691 /* Change from mapped state to withdrawn state. */
8692
8693 /* Make the frame visible (mapped and not iconified). */
8694
8695 void
8696 x_make_frame_invisible (f)
8697 struct frame *f;
8698 {
8699 Window window;
8700
8701 /* Use the frame's outermost window, not the one we normally draw on. */
8702 window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
8703
8704 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
8705 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
8706 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
8707
8708 #if 0/* This might add unreliability; I don't trust it -- rms. */
8709 if (! f->async_visible && ! f->async_iconified)
8710 return;
8711 #endif
8712
8713 BLOCK_INPUT;
8714
8715 /* Before unmapping the window, update the WM_SIZE_HINTS property to claim
8716 that the current position of the window is user-specified, rather than
8717 program-specified, so that when the window is mapped again, it will be
8718 placed at the same location, without forcing the user to position it
8719 by hand again (they have already done that once for this window.) */
8720 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 1);
8721
8722 #ifdef USE_GTK
8723 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
8724 gtk_widget_hide (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
8725 else
8726 #endif
8727 {
8728 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
8729
8730 if (! XWithdrawWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window,
8731 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))))
8732 {
8733 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
8734 error ("Can't notify window manager of window withdrawal");
8735 }
8736 #else /* ! defined (HAVE_X11R4) */
8737
8738 /* Tell the window manager what we're going to do. */
8739 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
8740 {
8741 XEvent unmap;
8742
8743 unmap.xunmap.type = UnmapNotify;
8744 unmap.xunmap.window = window;
8745 unmap.xunmap.event = DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8746 unmap.xunmap.from_configure = False;
8747 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
8748 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)),
8749 False,
8750 SubstructureRedirectMaskSubstructureNotifyMask,
8751 &unmap))
8752 {
8753 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
8754 error ("Can't notify window manager of withdrawal");
8755 }
8756 }
8757
8758 /* Unmap the window ourselves. Cheeky! */
8759 XUnmapWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window);
8760 #endif /* ! defined (HAVE_X11R4) */
8761 }
8762
8763 /* We can't distinguish this from iconification
8764 just by the event that we get from the server.
8765 So we can't win using the usual strategy of letting
8766 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY set this. So do it by hand,
8767 and synchronize with the server to make sure we agree. */
8768 f->visible = 0;
8769 FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f) = 0;
8770 f->async_visible = 0;
8771 f->async_iconified = 0;
8772
8773 x_sync (f);
8774
8775 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8776 }
8777
8778 /* Change window state from mapped to iconified. */
8779
8780 void
8781 x_iconify_frame (f)
8782 struct frame *f;
8783 {
8784 int result;
8785 Lisp_Object type;
8786
8787 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
8788 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
8789 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
8790
8791 if (f->async_iconified)
8792 return;
8793
8794 BLOCK_INPUT;
8795
8796 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
8797
8798 type = x_icon_type (f);
8799 if (!NILP (type))
8800 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
8801
8802 #ifdef USE_GTK
8803 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
8804 {
8805 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8806 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
8807
8808 gtk_window_iconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
8809 f->iconified = 1;
8810 f->visible = 1;
8811 f->async_iconified = 1;
8812 f->async_visible = 0;
8813 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8814 return;
8815 }
8816 #endif
8817
8818 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8819
8820 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8821 {
8822 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
8823 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
8824 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
8825 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
8826 /* The server won't give us any event to indicate
8827 that an invisible frame was changed to an icon,
8828 so we have to record it here. */
8829 f->iconified = 1;
8830 f->visible = 1;
8831 f->async_iconified = 1;
8832 f->async_visible = 0;
8833 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8834 return;
8835 }
8836
8837 result = XIconifyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
8838 XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget),
8839 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)));
8840 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8841
8842 if (!result)
8843 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
8844
8845 f->async_iconified = 1;
8846 f->async_visible = 0;
8847
8848
8849 BLOCK_INPUT;
8850 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8851 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8852 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8853
8854 /* Make sure the X server knows where the window should be positioned,
8855 in case the user deiconifies with the window manager. */
8856 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && !FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
8857 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
8858
8859 /* Since we don't know which revision of X we're running, we'll use both
8860 the X11R3 and X11R4 techniques. I don't know if this is a good idea. */
8861
8862 /* X11R4: send a ClientMessage to the window manager using the
8863 WM_CHANGE_STATE type. */
8864 {
8865 XEvent message;
8866
8867 message.xclient.window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
8868 message.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
8869 message.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_wm_change_state;
8870 message.xclient.format = 32;
8871 message.xclient.data.l[0] = IconicState;
8872
8873 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
8874 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)),
8875 False,
8876 SubstructureRedirectMask | SubstructureNotifyMask,
8877 &message))
8878 {
8879 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
8880 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
8881 }
8882 }
8883
8884 /* X11R3: set the initial_state field of the window manager hints to
8885 IconicState. */
8886 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
8887
8888 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8889 {
8890 /* If the frame was withdrawn, before, we must map it. */
8891 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
8892 }
8893
8894 f->async_iconified = 1;
8895 f->async_visible = 0;
8896
8897 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8898 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8899 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8900 }
8901
8902 \f
8903 /* Free X resources of frame F. */
8904
8905 void
8906 x_free_frame_resources (f)
8907 struct frame *f;
8908 {
8909 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8910 Lisp_Object bar;
8911 struct scroll_bar *b;
8912
8913 BLOCK_INPUT;
8914
8915 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
8916 commands to the X server. */
8917 if (dpyinfo->display)
8918 {
8919 if (f->output_data.x->icon_desc)
8920 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->icon_desc);
8921
8922 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8923 /* Explicitly destroy the scroll bars of the frame. Without
8924 this, we get "BadDrawable" errors from the toolkit later on,
8925 presumably from expose events generated for the disappearing
8926 toolkit scroll bars. */
8927 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); !NILP (bar); bar = b->next)
8928 {
8929 b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
8930 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
8931 }
8932 #endif
8933
8934 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
8935 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
8936 free_frame_xic (f);
8937 #endif
8938
8939 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8940 if (f->output_data.x->widget)
8941 {
8942 XtDestroyWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
8943 f->output_data.x->widget = NULL;
8944 }
8945 /* Tooltips don't have widgets, only a simple X window, even if
8946 we are using a toolkit. */
8947 else if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
8948 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
8949
8950 free_frame_menubar (f);
8951 #else /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8952
8953 #ifdef USE_GTK
8954 /* In the GTK version, tooltips are normal X
8955 frames. We must check and free both types. */
8956 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
8957 {
8958 gtk_widget_destroy (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
8959 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) = 0; /* Set to avoid XDestroyWindow below */
8960 FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f) = 0;
8961 }
8962 #endif /* USE_GTK */
8963
8964 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
8965 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
8966 #endif /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8967
8968 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->foreground_pixel);
8969 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->background_pixel);
8970 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel);
8971 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel);
8972 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
8973 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->mouse_pixel);
8974
8975 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel != -1)
8976 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel);
8977 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
8978 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
8979 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
8980 /* Scrollbar shadow colors. */
8981 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel != -1)
8982 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel);
8983 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel != -1)
8984 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel);
8985 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
8986 if (f->output_data.x->white_relief.allocated_p)
8987 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->white_relief.pixel);
8988 if (f->output_data.x->black_relief.allocated_p)
8989 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->black_relief.pixel);
8990
8991 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f))
8992 free_frame_faces (f);
8993
8994 x_free_gcs (f);
8995 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8996 }
8997
8998 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event)
8999 xfree (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event);
9000
9001 xfree (f->output_data.x);
9002 f->output_data.x = NULL;
9003
9004 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
9005 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
9006 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame)
9007 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
9008 if (f == dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
9009 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9010
9011 if (f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
9012 {
9013 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
9014 = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
9015 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row
9016 = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
9017 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
9018 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
9019 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
9020 }
9021
9022 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9023 }
9024
9025
9026 /* Destroy the X window of frame F. */
9027
9028 void
9029 x_destroy_window (f)
9030 struct frame *f;
9031 {
9032 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9033
9034 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9035 commands to the X server. */
9036 if (dpyinfo->display != 0)
9037 x_free_frame_resources (f);
9038
9039 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
9040 }
9041
9042 \f
9043 /* Setting window manager hints. */
9044
9045 /* Set the normal size hints for the window manager, for frame F.
9046 FLAGS is the flags word to use--or 0 meaning preserve the flags
9047 that the window now has.
9048 If USER_POSITION is nonzero, we set the USPosition
9049 flag (this is useful when FLAGS is 0).
9050 The GTK version is in gtkutils.c */
9051
9052 #ifndef USE_GTK
9053 void
9054 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, flags, user_position)
9055 struct frame *f;
9056 long flags;
9057 int user_position;
9058 {
9059 XSizeHints size_hints;
9060
9061 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9062 Arg al[2];
9063 int ac = 0;
9064 Dimension widget_width, widget_height;
9065 #endif
9066
9067 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9068
9069 /* Setting PMaxSize caused various problems. */
9070 size_hints.flags = PResizeInc | PMinSize /* | PMaxSize */;
9071
9072 size_hints.x = f->left_pos;
9073 size_hints.y = f->top_pos;
9074
9075 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9076 XtSetArg (al[ac], XtNwidth, &widget_width); ac++;
9077 XtSetArg (al[ac], XtNheight, &widget_height); ac++;
9078 XtGetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, ac);
9079 size_hints.height = widget_height;
9080 size_hints.width = widget_width;
9081 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9082 size_hints.height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
9083 size_hints.width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
9084 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9085
9086 size_hints.width_inc = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
9087 size_hints.height_inc = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
9088 size_hints.max_width
9089 = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->width - FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9090 size_hints.max_height
9091 = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->height - FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9092
9093 /* Calculate the base and minimum sizes.
9094
9095 (When we use the X toolkit, we don't do it here.
9096 Instead we copy the values that the widgets are using, below.) */
9097 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9098 {
9099 int base_width, base_height;
9100 int min_rows = 0, min_cols = 0;
9101
9102 base_width = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9103 base_height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9104
9105 check_frame_size (f, &min_rows, &min_cols);
9106
9107 /* The window manager uses the base width hints to calculate the
9108 current number of rows and columns in the frame while
9109 resizing; min_width and min_height aren't useful for this
9110 purpose, since they might not give the dimensions for a
9111 zero-row, zero-column frame.
9112
9113 We use the base_width and base_height members if we have
9114 them; otherwise, we set the min_width and min_height members
9115 to the size for a zero x zero frame. */
9116
9117 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
9118 size_hints.flags |= PBaseSize;
9119 size_hints.base_width = base_width;
9120 size_hints.base_height = base_height;
9121 size_hints.min_width = base_width + min_cols * size_hints.width_inc;
9122 size_hints.min_height = base_height + min_rows * size_hints.height_inc;
9123 #else
9124 size_hints.min_width = base_width;
9125 size_hints.min_height = base_height;
9126 #endif
9127 }
9128
9129 /* If we don't need the old flags, we don't need the old hint at all. */
9130 if (flags)
9131 {
9132 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9133 goto no_read;
9134 }
9135 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9136
9137 {
9138 XSizeHints hints; /* Sometimes I hate X Windows... */
9139 long supplied_return;
9140 int value;
9141
9142 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
9143 value = XGetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &hints,
9144 &supplied_return);
9145 #else
9146 value = XGetNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &hints);
9147 #endif
9148
9149 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9150 size_hints.base_height = hints.base_height;
9151 size_hints.base_width = hints.base_width;
9152 size_hints.min_height = hints.min_height;
9153 size_hints.min_width = hints.min_width;
9154 #endif
9155
9156 if (flags)
9157 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9158 else
9159 {
9160 if (value == 0)
9161 hints.flags = 0;
9162 if (hints.flags & PSize)
9163 size_hints.flags |= PSize;
9164 if (hints.flags & PPosition)
9165 size_hints.flags |= PPosition;
9166 if (hints.flags & USPosition)
9167 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9168 if (hints.flags & USSize)
9169 size_hints.flags |= USSize;
9170 }
9171 }
9172
9173 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9174 no_read:
9175 #endif
9176
9177 #ifdef PWinGravity
9178 size_hints.win_gravity = f->win_gravity;
9179 size_hints.flags |= PWinGravity;
9180
9181 if (user_position)
9182 {
9183 size_hints.flags &= ~ PPosition;
9184 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9185 }
9186 #endif /* PWinGravity */
9187
9188 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
9189 XSetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &size_hints);
9190 #else
9191 XSetNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &size_hints);
9192 #endif
9193 }
9194 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9195
9196 /* Used for IconicState or NormalState */
9197
9198 void
9199 x_wm_set_window_state (f, state)
9200 struct frame *f;
9201 int state;
9202 {
9203 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9204 Arg al[1];
9205
9206 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNinitialState, state);
9207 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9208 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9209 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9210
9211 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= StateHint;
9212 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.initial_state = state;
9213
9214 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9215 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9216 }
9217
9218 void
9219 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, pixmap_id)
9220 struct frame *f;
9221 int pixmap_id;
9222 {
9223 Pixmap icon_pixmap, icon_mask;
9224
9225 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9226 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9227 #endif
9228
9229 if (pixmap_id > 0)
9230 {
9231 icon_pixmap = x_bitmap_pixmap (f, pixmap_id);
9232 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = icon_pixmap;
9233 icon_mask = x_bitmap_mask (f, pixmap_id);
9234 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_mask = icon_mask;
9235 }
9236 else
9237 {
9238 /* It seems there is no way to turn off use of an icon pixmap.
9239 The following line does it, only if no icon has yet been created,
9240 for some window managers. But with mwm it crashes.
9241 Some people say it should clear the IconPixmapHint bit in this case,
9242 but that doesn't work, and the X consortium said it isn't the
9243 right thing at all. Since there is no way to win,
9244 best to explicitly give up. */
9245 #if 0
9246 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = None;
9247 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_mask = None;
9248 #else
9249 return;
9250 #endif
9251 }
9252
9253 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT /* same as in x_wm_set_window_state. */
9254
9255 {
9256 Arg al[1];
9257 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconPixmap, icon_pixmap);
9258 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9259 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconMask, icon_mask);
9260 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9261 }
9262
9263 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9264
9265 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= (IconPixmapHint | IconMaskHint);
9266 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9267
9268 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9269 }
9270
9271 void
9272 x_wm_set_icon_position (f, icon_x, icon_y)
9273 struct frame *f;
9274 int icon_x, icon_y;
9275 {
9276 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9277
9278 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= IconPositionHint;
9279 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_x = icon_x;
9280 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_y = icon_y;
9281
9282 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9283 }
9284
9285 \f
9286 /***********************************************************************
9287 Fonts
9288 ***********************************************************************/
9289
9290 /* Return a pointer to struct font_info of font FONT_IDX of frame F. */
9291
9292 struct font_info *
9293 x_get_font_info (f, font_idx)
9294 FRAME_PTR f;
9295 int font_idx;
9296 {
9297 return (FRAME_X_FONT_TABLE (f) + font_idx);
9298 }
9299
9300
9301 /* Return a list of names of available fonts matching PATTERN on frame F.
9302
9303 If SIZE is > 0, it is the size (maximum bounds width) of fonts
9304 to be listed.
9305
9306 SIZE < 0 means include scalable fonts.
9307
9308 Frame F null means we have not yet created any frame on X, and
9309 consult the first display in x_display_list. MAXNAMES sets a limit
9310 on how many fonts to match. */
9311
9312 Lisp_Object
9313 x_list_fonts (f, pattern, size, maxnames)
9314 struct frame *f;
9315 Lisp_Object pattern;
9316 int size;
9317 int maxnames;
9318 {
9319 Lisp_Object list = Qnil, patterns, newlist = Qnil, key = Qnil;
9320 Lisp_Object tem, second_best;
9321 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo
9322 = f ? FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) : x_display_list;
9323 Display *dpy = dpyinfo->display;
9324 int try_XLoadQueryFont = 0;
9325 int count;
9326 int allow_auto_scaled_font = 0;
9327
9328 if (size < 0)
9329 {
9330 allow_auto_scaled_font = 1;
9331 size = 0;
9332 }
9333
9334 patterns = Fassoc (pattern, Valternate_fontname_alist);
9335 if (NILP (patterns))
9336 patterns = Fcons (pattern, Qnil);
9337
9338 if (maxnames == 1 && !size)
9339 /* We can return any single font matching PATTERN. */
9340 try_XLoadQueryFont = 1;
9341
9342 for (; CONSP (patterns); patterns = XCDR (patterns))
9343 {
9344 int num_fonts;
9345 char **names = NULL;
9346
9347 pattern = XCAR (patterns);
9348 /* See if we cached the result for this particular query.
9349 The cache is an alist of the form:
9350 ((((PATTERN . MAXNAMES) . SCALABLE) (FONTNAME . WIDTH) ...) ...) */
9351 tem = XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element);
9352 key = Fcons (Fcons (pattern, make_number (maxnames)),
9353 allow_auto_scaled_font ? Qt : Qnil);
9354 list = Fassoc (key, tem);
9355 if (!NILP (list))
9356 {
9357 list = Fcdr_safe (list);
9358 /* We have a cashed list. Don't have to get the list again. */
9359 goto label_cached;
9360 }
9361
9362 /* At first, put PATTERN in the cache. */
9363
9364 BLOCK_INPUT;
9365 count = x_catch_errors (dpy);
9366
9367 if (try_XLoadQueryFont)
9368 {
9369 XFontStruct *font;
9370 unsigned long value;
9371
9372 font = XLoadQueryFont (dpy, SDATA (pattern));
9373 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
9374 {
9375 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
9376 server. Let's just ignore it. */
9377 font = NULL;
9378 x_clear_errors (dpy);
9379 }
9380
9381 if (font
9382 && XGetFontProperty (font, XA_FONT, &value))
9383 {
9384 char *name = (char *) XGetAtomName (dpy, (Atom) value);
9385 int len = strlen (name);
9386 char *tmp;
9387
9388 /* If DXPC (a Differential X Protocol Compressor)
9389 Ver.3.7 is running, XGetAtomName will return null
9390 string. We must avoid such a name. */
9391 if (len == 0)
9392 try_XLoadQueryFont = 0;
9393 else
9394 {
9395 num_fonts = 1;
9396 names = (char **) alloca (sizeof (char *));
9397 /* Some systems only allow alloca assigned to a
9398 simple var. */
9399 tmp = (char *) alloca (len + 1); names[0] = tmp;
9400 bcopy (name, names[0], len + 1);
9401 XFree (name);
9402 }
9403 }
9404 else
9405 try_XLoadQueryFont = 0;
9406
9407 if (font)
9408 XFreeFont (dpy, font);
9409 }
9410
9411 if (!try_XLoadQueryFont)
9412 {
9413 /* We try at least 10 fonts because XListFonts will return
9414 auto-scaled fonts at the head. */
9415 if (maxnames < 0)
9416 {
9417 int limit;
9418
9419 for (limit = 500;;)
9420 {
9421 names = XListFonts (dpy, SDATA (pattern), limit, &num_fonts);
9422 if (num_fonts == limit)
9423 {
9424 BLOCK_INPUT;
9425 XFreeFontNames (names);
9426 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9427 limit *= 2;
9428 }
9429 else
9430 break;
9431 }
9432 }
9433 else
9434 names = XListFonts (dpy, SDATA (pattern), max (maxnames, 10),
9435 &num_fonts);
9436
9437 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
9438 {
9439 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
9440 server. Let's just ignore it. */
9441 names = NULL;
9442 x_clear_errors (dpy);
9443 }
9444 }
9445
9446 x_uncatch_errors (dpy, count);
9447 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9448
9449 if (names)
9450 {
9451 int i;
9452
9453 /* Make a list of all the fonts we got back.
9454 Store that in the font cache for the display. */
9455 for (i = 0; i < num_fonts; i++)
9456 {
9457 int width = 0;
9458 char *p = names[i];
9459 int average_width = -1, resx = 0, dashes = 0;
9460
9461 /* Count the number of dashes in NAMES[I]. If there are
9462 14 dashes, the field value following 9th dash
9463 (RESOLUTION_X) is nonzero, and the field value
9464 following 12th dash (AVERAGE_WIDTH) is 0, this is a
9465 auto-scaled font which is usually too ugly to be used
9466 for editing. Let's ignore it. */
9467 while (*p)
9468 if (*p++ == '-')
9469 {
9470 dashes++;
9471 if (dashes == 7) /* PIXEL_SIZE field */
9472 width = atoi (p);
9473 else if (dashes == 9)
9474 resx = atoi (p);
9475 else if (dashes == 12) /* AVERAGE_WIDTH field */
9476 average_width = atoi (p);
9477 }
9478
9479 if (allow_auto_scaled_font
9480 || dashes < 14 || average_width != 0 || resx == 0)
9481 {
9482 tem = build_string (names[i]);
9483 if (NILP (Fassoc (tem, list)))
9484 {
9485 if (STRINGP (Vx_pixel_size_width_font_regexp)
9486 && ((fast_c_string_match_ignore_case
9487 (Vx_pixel_size_width_font_regexp, names[i]))
9488 >= 0))
9489 /* We can set the value of PIXEL_SIZE to the
9490 width of this font. */
9491 list = Fcons (Fcons (tem, make_number (width)), list);
9492 else
9493 /* For the moment, width is not known. */
9494 list = Fcons (Fcons (tem, Qnil), list);
9495 }
9496 }
9497 }
9498
9499 if (!try_XLoadQueryFont)
9500 {
9501 BLOCK_INPUT;
9502 XFreeFontNames (names);
9503 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9504 }
9505 }
9506
9507 /* Now store the result in the cache. */
9508 XSETCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element,
9509 Fcons (Fcons (key, list), XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element)));
9510
9511 label_cached:
9512 if (NILP (list)) continue; /* Try the remaining alternatives. */
9513
9514 newlist = second_best = Qnil;
9515 /* Make a list of the fonts that have the right width. */
9516 for (; CONSP (list); list = XCDR (list))
9517 {
9518 int found_size;
9519
9520 tem = XCAR (list);
9521
9522 if (!CONSP (tem) || NILP (XCAR (tem)))
9523 continue;
9524 if (!size)
9525 {
9526 newlist = Fcons (XCAR (tem), newlist);
9527 continue;
9528 }
9529
9530 if (!INTEGERP (XCDR (tem)))
9531 {
9532 /* Since we have not yet known the size of this font, we
9533 must try slow function call XLoadQueryFont. */
9534 XFontStruct *thisinfo;
9535
9536 BLOCK_INPUT;
9537 count = x_catch_errors (dpy);
9538 thisinfo = XLoadQueryFont (dpy,
9539 SDATA (XCAR (tem)));
9540 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
9541 {
9542 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
9543 server. Let's just ignore it. */
9544 thisinfo = NULL;
9545 x_clear_errors (dpy);
9546 }
9547 x_uncatch_errors (dpy, count);
9548 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9549
9550 if (thisinfo)
9551 {
9552 XSETCDR (tem,
9553 (thisinfo->min_bounds.width == 0
9554 ? make_number (0)
9555 : make_number (thisinfo->max_bounds.width)));
9556 BLOCK_INPUT;
9557 XFreeFont (dpy, thisinfo);
9558 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9559 }
9560 else
9561 /* For unknown reason, the previous call of XListFont had
9562 returned a font which can't be opened. Record the size
9563 as 0 not to try to open it again. */
9564 XSETCDR (tem, make_number (0));
9565 }
9566
9567 found_size = XINT (XCDR (tem));
9568 if (found_size == size)
9569 newlist = Fcons (XCAR (tem), newlist);
9570 else if (found_size > 0)
9571 {
9572 if (NILP (second_best))
9573 second_best = tem;
9574 else if (found_size < size)
9575 {
9576 if (XINT (XCDR (second_best)) > size
9577 || XINT (XCDR (second_best)) < found_size)
9578 second_best = tem;
9579 }
9580 else
9581 {
9582 if (XINT (XCDR (second_best)) > size
9583 && XINT (XCDR (second_best)) > found_size)
9584 second_best = tem;
9585 }
9586 }
9587 }
9588 if (!NILP (newlist))
9589 break;
9590 else if (!NILP (second_best))
9591 {
9592 newlist = Fcons (XCAR (second_best), Qnil);
9593 break;
9594 }
9595 }
9596
9597 return newlist;
9598 }
9599
9600
9601 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
9602
9603 /* Check that FONT is valid on frame F. It is if it can be found in F's
9604 font table. */
9605
9606 static void
9607 x_check_font (f, font)
9608 struct frame *f;
9609 XFontStruct *font;
9610 {
9611 int i;
9612 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9613
9614 xassert (font != NULL);
9615
9616 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
9617 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name
9618 && font == dpyinfo->font_table[i].font)
9619 break;
9620
9621 xassert (i < dpyinfo->n_fonts);
9622 }
9623
9624 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG != 0 */
9625
9626 /* Set *W to the minimum width, *H to the minimum font height of FONT.
9627 Note: There are (broken) X fonts out there with invalid XFontStruct
9628 min_bounds contents. For example, handa@etl.go.jp reports that
9629 "-adobe-courier-medium-r-normal--*-180-*-*-m-*-iso8859-1" fonts
9630 have font->min_bounds.width == 0. */
9631
9632 static INLINE void
9633 x_font_min_bounds (font, w, h)
9634 XFontStruct *font;
9635 int *w, *h;
9636 {
9637 *h = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
9638 *w = font->min_bounds.width;
9639
9640 /* Try to handle the case where FONT->min_bounds has invalid
9641 contents. Since the only font known to have invalid min_bounds
9642 is fixed-width, use max_bounds if min_bounds seems to be invalid. */
9643 if (*w <= 0)
9644 *w = font->max_bounds.width;
9645 }
9646
9647
9648 /* Compute the smallest character width and smallest font height over
9649 all fonts available on frame F. Set the members smallest_char_width
9650 and smallest_font_height in F's x_display_info structure to
9651 the values computed. Value is non-zero if smallest_font_height or
9652 smallest_char_width become smaller than they were before. */
9653
9654 static int
9655 x_compute_min_glyph_bounds (f)
9656 struct frame *f;
9657 {
9658 int i;
9659 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9660 XFontStruct *font;
9661 int old_width = dpyinfo->smallest_char_width;
9662 int old_height = dpyinfo->smallest_font_height;
9663
9664 dpyinfo->smallest_font_height = 100000;
9665 dpyinfo->smallest_char_width = 100000;
9666
9667 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; ++i)
9668 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name)
9669 {
9670 struct font_info *fontp = dpyinfo->font_table + i;
9671 int w, h;
9672
9673 font = (XFontStruct *) fontp->font;
9674 xassert (font != (XFontStruct *) ~0);
9675 x_font_min_bounds (font, &w, &h);
9676
9677 dpyinfo->smallest_font_height = min (dpyinfo->smallest_font_height, h);
9678 dpyinfo->smallest_char_width = min (dpyinfo->smallest_char_width, w);
9679 }
9680
9681 xassert (dpyinfo->smallest_char_width > 0
9682 && dpyinfo->smallest_font_height > 0);
9683
9684 return (dpyinfo->n_fonts == 1
9685 || dpyinfo->smallest_char_width < old_width
9686 || dpyinfo->smallest_font_height < old_height);
9687 }
9688
9689
9690 /* Load font named FONTNAME of the size SIZE for frame F, and return a
9691 pointer to the structure font_info while allocating it dynamically.
9692 If SIZE is 0, load any size of font.
9693 If loading is failed, return NULL. */
9694
9695 struct font_info *
9696 x_load_font (f, fontname, size)
9697 struct frame *f;
9698 register char *fontname;
9699 int size;
9700 {
9701 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9702 Lisp_Object font_names;
9703 int count;
9704
9705 /* Get a list of all the fonts that match this name. Once we
9706 have a list of matching fonts, we compare them against the fonts
9707 we already have by comparing names. */
9708 font_names = x_list_fonts (f, build_string (fontname), size, 1);
9709
9710 if (!NILP (font_names))
9711 {
9712 Lisp_Object tail;
9713 int i;
9714
9715 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
9716 for (tail = font_names; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
9717 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name
9718 && (!strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name,
9719 SDATA (XCAR (tail)))
9720 || !strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name,
9721 SDATA (XCAR (tail)))))
9722 return (dpyinfo->font_table + i);
9723 }
9724
9725 /* Load the font and add it to the table. */
9726 {
9727 char *full_name;
9728 XFontStruct *font;
9729 struct font_info *fontp;
9730 unsigned long value;
9731 int i;
9732
9733 /* If we have found fonts by x_list_font, load one of them. If
9734 not, we still try to load a font by the name given as FONTNAME
9735 because XListFonts (called in x_list_font) of some X server has
9736 a bug of not finding a font even if the font surely exists and
9737 is loadable by XLoadQueryFont. */
9738 if (size > 0 && !NILP (font_names))
9739 fontname = (char *) SDATA (XCAR (font_names));
9740
9741 BLOCK_INPUT;
9742 count = x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9743 font = (XFontStruct *) XLoadQueryFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), fontname);
9744 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)))
9745 {
9746 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
9747 server. Let's just ignore it. */
9748 font = NULL;
9749 x_clear_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9750 }
9751 x_uncatch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), count);
9752 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9753 if (!font)
9754 return NULL;
9755
9756 /* Find a free slot in the font table. */
9757 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; ++i)
9758 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name == NULL)
9759 break;
9760
9761 /* If no free slot found, maybe enlarge the font table. */
9762 if (i == dpyinfo->n_fonts
9763 && dpyinfo->n_fonts == dpyinfo->font_table_size)
9764 {
9765 int sz;
9766 dpyinfo->font_table_size = max (16, 2 * dpyinfo->font_table_size);
9767 sz = dpyinfo->font_table_size * sizeof *dpyinfo->font_table;
9768 dpyinfo->font_table
9769 = (struct font_info *) xrealloc (dpyinfo->font_table, sz);
9770 }
9771
9772 fontp = dpyinfo->font_table + i;
9773 if (i == dpyinfo->n_fonts)
9774 ++dpyinfo->n_fonts;
9775
9776 /* Now fill in the slots of *FONTP. */
9777 BLOCK_INPUT;
9778 bzero (fontp, sizeof (*fontp));
9779 fontp->font = font;
9780 fontp->font_idx = i;
9781 fontp->name = (char *) xmalloc (strlen (fontname) + 1);
9782 bcopy (fontname, fontp->name, strlen (fontname) + 1);
9783
9784 if (font->min_bounds.width == font->max_bounds.width)
9785 {
9786 /* Fixed width font. */
9787 fontp->average_width = fontp->space_width = font->min_bounds.width;
9788 }
9789 else
9790 {
9791 XChar2b char2b;
9792 XCharStruct *pcm;
9793
9794 char2b.byte1 = 0x00, char2b.byte2 = 0x20;
9795 pcm = x_per_char_metric (font, &char2b, 0);
9796 if (pcm)
9797 fontp->space_width = pcm->width;
9798 else
9799 fontp->space_width = FONT_WIDTH (font);
9800
9801 fontp->average_width
9802 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_AVERAGE_WIDTH, &value)
9803 ? (long) value / 10 : 0);
9804 if (fontp->average_width < 0)
9805 fontp->average_width = - fontp->average_width;
9806 if (fontp->average_width == 0)
9807 {
9808 if (pcm)
9809 {
9810 int width = pcm->width;
9811 for (char2b.byte2 = 33; char2b.byte2 <= 126; char2b.byte2++)
9812 if ((pcm = x_per_char_metric (font, &char2b, 0)) != NULL)
9813 width += pcm->width;
9814 fontp->average_width = width / 95;
9815 }
9816 else
9817 fontp->average_width = FONT_WIDTH (font);
9818 }
9819 }
9820
9821 /* Try to get the full name of FONT. Put it in FULL_NAME. */
9822 full_name = 0;
9823 if (XGetFontProperty (font, XA_FONT, &value))
9824 {
9825 char *name = (char *) XGetAtomName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), (Atom) value);
9826 char *p = name;
9827 int dashes = 0;
9828
9829 /* Count the number of dashes in the "full name".
9830 If it is too few, this isn't really the font's full name,
9831 so don't use it.
9832 In X11R4, the fonts did not come with their canonical names
9833 stored in them. */
9834 while (*p)
9835 {
9836 if (*p == '-')
9837 dashes++;
9838 p++;
9839 }
9840
9841 if (dashes >= 13)
9842 {
9843 full_name = (char *) xmalloc (p - name + 1);
9844 bcopy (name, full_name, p - name + 1);
9845 }
9846
9847 XFree (name);
9848 }
9849
9850 if (full_name != 0)
9851 fontp->full_name = full_name;
9852 else
9853 fontp->full_name = fontp->name;
9854
9855 fontp->size = font->max_bounds.width;
9856 fontp->height = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
9857
9858 if (NILP (font_names))
9859 {
9860 /* We come here because of a bug of XListFonts mentioned at
9861 the head of this block. Let's store this information in
9862 the cache for x_list_fonts. */
9863 Lisp_Object lispy_name = build_string (fontname);
9864 Lisp_Object lispy_full_name = build_string (fontp->full_name);
9865 Lisp_Object key = Fcons (Fcons (lispy_name, make_number (256)),
9866 Qnil);
9867
9868 XSETCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element,
9869 Fcons (Fcons (key,
9870 Fcons (Fcons (lispy_full_name,
9871 make_number (fontp->size)),
9872 Qnil)),
9873 XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element)));
9874 if (full_name)
9875 {
9876 key = Fcons (Fcons (lispy_full_name, make_number (256)),
9877 Qnil);
9878 XSETCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element,
9879 Fcons (Fcons (key,
9880 Fcons (Fcons (lispy_full_name,
9881 make_number (fontp->size)),
9882 Qnil)),
9883 XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element)));
9884 }
9885 }
9886
9887 /* The slot `encoding' specifies how to map a character
9888 code-points (0x20..0x7F or 0x2020..0x7F7F) of each charset to
9889 the font code-points (0:0x20..0x7F, 1:0xA0..0xFF), or
9890 (0:0x2020..0x7F7F, 1:0xA0A0..0xFFFF, 3:0x20A0..0x7FFF,
9891 2:0xA020..0xFF7F). For the moment, we don't know which charset
9892 uses this font. So, we set information in fontp->encoding[1]
9893 which is never used by any charset. If mapping can't be
9894 decided, set FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED. */
9895 fontp->encoding[1]
9896 = (font->max_byte1 == 0
9897 /* 1-byte font */
9898 ? (font->min_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9899 ? (font->max_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9900 ? 0 /* 0x20..0x7F */
9901 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0x20..0xFF */
9902 : 1) /* 0xA0..0xFF */
9903 /* 2-byte font */
9904 : (font->min_byte1 < 0x80
9905 ? (font->max_byte1 < 0x80
9906 ? (font->min_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9907 ? (font->max_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9908 ? 0 /* 0x2020..0x7F7F */
9909 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0x2020..0x7FFF */
9910 : 3) /* 0x20A0..0x7FFF */
9911 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0x20??..0xA0?? */
9912 : (font->min_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9913 ? (font->max_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9914 ? 2 /* 0xA020..0xFF7F */
9915 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0xA020..0xFFFF */
9916 : 1))); /* 0xA0A0..0xFFFF */
9917
9918 fontp->baseline_offset
9919 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET, &value)
9920 ? (long) value : 0);
9921 fontp->relative_compose
9922 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE, &value)
9923 ? (long) value : 0);
9924 fontp->default_ascent
9925 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT, &value)
9926 ? (long) value : 0);
9927
9928 /* Set global flag fonts_changed_p to non-zero if the font loaded
9929 has a character with a smaller width than any other character
9930 before, or if the font loaded has a smaller height than any
9931 other font loaded before. If this happens, it will make a
9932 glyph matrix reallocation necessary. */
9933 fonts_changed_p |= x_compute_min_glyph_bounds (f);
9934 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9935 return fontp;
9936 }
9937 }
9938
9939
9940 /* Return a pointer to struct font_info of a font named FONTNAME for
9941 frame F. If no such font is loaded, return NULL. */
9942
9943 struct font_info *
9944 x_query_font (f, fontname)
9945 struct frame *f;
9946 register char *fontname;
9947 {
9948 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9949 int i;
9950
9951 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
9952 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name
9953 && (!strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name, fontname)
9954 || !strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name, fontname)))
9955 return (dpyinfo->font_table + i);
9956 return NULL;
9957 }
9958
9959
9960 /* Find a CCL program for a font specified by FONTP, and set the member
9961 `encoder' of the structure. */
9962
9963 void
9964 x_find_ccl_program (fontp)
9965 struct font_info *fontp;
9966 {
9967 Lisp_Object list, elt;
9968
9969 elt = Qnil;
9970 for (list = Vfont_ccl_encoder_alist; CONSP (list); list = XCDR (list))
9971 {
9972 elt = XCAR (list);
9973 if (CONSP (elt)
9974 && STRINGP (XCAR (elt))
9975 && ((fast_c_string_match_ignore_case (XCAR (elt), fontp->name)
9976 >= 0)
9977 || (fast_c_string_match_ignore_case (XCAR (elt), fontp->full_name)
9978 >= 0)))
9979 break;
9980 }
9981
9982 if (! NILP (list))
9983 {
9984 struct ccl_program *ccl
9985 = (struct ccl_program *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct ccl_program));
9986
9987 if (setup_ccl_program (ccl, XCDR (elt)) < 0)
9988 xfree (ccl);
9989 else
9990 fontp->font_encoder = ccl;
9991 }
9992 }
9993
9994
9995 \f
9996 /***********************************************************************
9997 Initialization
9998 ***********************************************************************/
9999
10000 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10001 static XrmOptionDescRec emacs_options[] = {
10002 {"-geometry", ".geometry", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
10003 {"-iconic", ".iconic", XrmoptionNoArg, (XtPointer) "yes"},
10004
10005 {"-internal-border-width", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth",
10006 XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
10007 {"-ib", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
10008
10009 {"-T", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10010 {"-wn", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10011 {"-title", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10012 {"-iconname", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10013 {"-in", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10014 {"-mc", "*pointerColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10015 {"-cr", "*cursorColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL}
10016 };
10017 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10018
10019 static int x_initialized;
10020
10021 #ifdef MULTI_KBOARD
10022 /* Test whether two display-name strings agree up to the dot that separates
10023 the screen number from the server number. */
10024 static int
10025 same_x_server (name1, name2)
10026 const char *name1, *name2;
10027 {
10028 int seen_colon = 0;
10029 const unsigned char *system_name = SDATA (Vsystem_name);
10030 int system_name_length = strlen (system_name);
10031 int length_until_period = 0;
10032
10033 while (system_name[length_until_period] != 0
10034 && system_name[length_until_period] != '.')
10035 length_until_period++;
10036
10037 /* Treat `unix' like an empty host name. */
10038 if (! strncmp (name1, "unix:", 5))
10039 name1 += 4;
10040 if (! strncmp (name2, "unix:", 5))
10041 name2 += 4;
10042 /* Treat this host's name like an empty host name. */
10043 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, system_name_length)
10044 && name1[system_name_length] == ':')
10045 name1 += system_name_length;
10046 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, system_name_length)
10047 && name2[system_name_length] == ':')
10048 name2 += system_name_length;
10049 /* Treat this host's domainless name like an empty host name. */
10050 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, length_until_period)
10051 && name1[length_until_period] == ':')
10052 name1 += length_until_period;
10053 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, length_until_period)
10054 && name2[length_until_period] == ':')
10055 name2 += length_until_period;
10056
10057 for (; *name1 != '\0' && *name1 == *name2; name1++, name2++)
10058 {
10059 if (*name1 == ':')
10060 seen_colon++;
10061 if (seen_colon && *name1 == '.')
10062 return 1;
10063 }
10064 return (seen_colon
10065 && (*name1 == '.' || *name1 == '\0')
10066 && (*name2 == '.' || *name2 == '\0'));
10067 }
10068 #endif
10069
10070 /* Count number of set bits in mask and number of bits to shift to
10071 get to the first bit. With MASK 0x7e0, *BITS is set to 6, and *OFFSET
10072 to 5. */
10073 static void
10074 get_bits_and_offset (mask, bits, offset)
10075 unsigned long mask;
10076 int *bits;
10077 int *offset;
10078 {
10079 int nr = 0;
10080 int off = 0;
10081
10082 while (!(mask & 1))
10083 {
10084 off++;
10085 mask >>= 1;
10086 }
10087
10088 while (mask & 1)
10089 {
10090 nr++;
10091 mask >>= 1;
10092 }
10093
10094 *offset = off;
10095 *bits = nr;
10096 }
10097
10098 struct x_display_info *
10099 x_term_init (display_name, xrm_option, resource_name)
10100 Lisp_Object display_name;
10101 char *xrm_option;
10102 char *resource_name;
10103 {
10104 int connection;
10105 Display *dpy;
10106 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
10107 XrmDatabase xrdb;
10108
10109 BLOCK_INPUT;
10110
10111 if (!x_initialized)
10112 {
10113 x_initialize ();
10114 ++x_initialized;
10115 }
10116
10117 #ifdef USE_GTK
10118 {
10119 #define NUM_ARGV 10
10120 int argc;
10121 char *argv[NUM_ARGV];
10122 char **argv2 = argv;
10123 GdkAtom atom;
10124
10125 if (x_initialized++ > 1)
10126 {
10127 /* Opening another display. If xg_display_open returns less
10128 than zero, we are probably on GTK 2.0, which can only handle
10129 one display. GTK 2.2 or later can handle more than one. */
10130 if (xg_display_open (SDATA (display_name), &dpy) < 0)
10131 error ("Sorry, this version of GTK can only handle one display");
10132 }
10133 else
10134 {
10135 for (argc = 0; argc < NUM_ARGV; ++argc)
10136 argv[argc] = 0;
10137
10138 argc = 0;
10139 argv[argc++] = initial_argv[0];
10140
10141 if (! NILP (display_name))
10142 {
10143 argv[argc++] = "--display";
10144 argv[argc++] = SDATA (display_name);
10145 }
10146
10147 argv[argc++] = "--name";
10148 argv[argc++] = resource_name;
10149
10150 #ifdef HAVE_X11R5
10151 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
10152 #endif
10153
10154 gtk_init (&argc, &argv2);
10155
10156 /* gtk_init does set_locale. We must fix locale after calling it. */
10157 fixup_locale ();
10158 xg_initialize ();
10159
10160 dpy = GDK_DISPLAY ();
10161
10162 /* NULL window -> events for all windows go to our function */
10163 gdk_window_add_filter (NULL, event_handler_gdk, NULL);
10164
10165 /* Load our own gtkrc if it exists. */
10166 {
10167 struct gcpro gcpro1, gcpro2;
10168 char *file = "~/.emacs.d/gtkrc";
10169 Lisp_Object s, abs_file;
10170
10171 GCPRO2 (s, abs_file);
10172 s = make_string (file, strlen (file));
10173 abs_file = Fexpand_file_name (s, Qnil);
10174
10175 if (! NILP (abs_file) && !NILP (Ffile_readable_p (abs_file)))
10176 gtk_rc_parse (SDATA (abs_file));
10177
10178 UNGCPRO;
10179 }
10180
10181 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
10182 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
10183 }
10184 }
10185 #else /* not USE_GTK */
10186 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10187 /* weiner@footloose.sps.mot.com reports that this causes
10188 errors with X11R5:
10189 X protocol error: BadAtom (invalid Atom parameter)
10190 on protocol request 18skiloaf.
10191 So let's not use it until R6. */
10192 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
10193 XtSetLanguageProc (NULL, NULL, NULL);
10194 #endif
10195
10196 {
10197 int argc = 0;
10198 char *argv[3];
10199
10200 argv[0] = "";
10201 argc = 1;
10202 if (xrm_option)
10203 {
10204 argv[argc++] = "-xrm";
10205 argv[argc++] = xrm_option;
10206 }
10207 turn_on_atimers (0);
10208 dpy = XtOpenDisplay (Xt_app_con, SDATA (display_name),
10209 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
10210 emacs_options, XtNumber (emacs_options),
10211 &argc, argv);
10212 turn_on_atimers (1);
10213
10214 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
10215 /* I think this is to compensate for XtSetLanguageProc. */
10216 fixup_locale ();
10217 #endif
10218 }
10219
10220 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10221 #ifdef HAVE_X11R5
10222 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
10223 #endif
10224 dpy = XOpenDisplay (SDATA (display_name));
10225 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10226 #endif /* not USE_GTK*/
10227
10228 /* Detect failure. */
10229 if (dpy == 0)
10230 {
10231 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10232 return 0;
10233 }
10234
10235 /* We have definitely succeeded. Record the new connection. */
10236
10237 dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct x_display_info));
10238 bzero (dpyinfo, sizeof *dpyinfo);
10239
10240 #ifdef MULTI_KBOARD
10241 {
10242 struct x_display_info *share;
10243 Lisp_Object tail;
10244
10245 for (share = x_display_list, tail = x_display_name_list; share;
10246 share = share->next, tail = XCDR (tail))
10247 if (same_x_server (SDATA (XCAR (XCAR (tail))),
10248 SDATA (display_name)))
10249 break;
10250 if (share)
10251 dpyinfo->kboard = share->kboard;
10252 else
10253 {
10254 dpyinfo->kboard = (KBOARD *) xmalloc (sizeof (KBOARD));
10255 init_kboard (dpyinfo->kboard);
10256 if (!EQ (XSYMBOL (Qvendor_specific_keysyms)->function, Qunbound))
10257 {
10258 char *vendor = ServerVendor (dpy);
10259 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10260 dpyinfo->kboard->Vsystem_key_alist
10261 = call1 (Qvendor_specific_keysyms,
10262 build_string (vendor ? vendor : ""));
10263 BLOCK_INPUT;
10264 }
10265
10266 dpyinfo->kboard->next_kboard = all_kboards;
10267 all_kboards = dpyinfo->kboard;
10268 /* Don't let the initial kboard remain current longer than necessary.
10269 That would cause problems if a file loaded on startup tries to
10270 prompt in the mini-buffer. */
10271 if (current_kboard == initial_kboard)
10272 current_kboard = dpyinfo->kboard;
10273 }
10274 dpyinfo->kboard->reference_count++;
10275 }
10276 #endif
10277
10278 /* Put this display on the chain. */
10279 dpyinfo->next = x_display_list;
10280 x_display_list = dpyinfo;
10281
10282 /* Put it on x_display_name_list as well, to keep them parallel. */
10283 x_display_name_list = Fcons (Fcons (display_name, Qnil),
10284 x_display_name_list);
10285 dpyinfo->name_list_element = XCAR (x_display_name_list);
10286
10287 dpyinfo->display = dpy;
10288
10289 #if 0
10290 XSetAfterFunction (x_current_display, x_trace_wire);
10291 #endif /* ! 0 */
10292
10293 dpyinfo->x_id_name
10294 = (char *) xmalloc (SBYTES (Vinvocation_name)
10295 + SBYTES (Vsystem_name)
10296 + 2);
10297 sprintf (dpyinfo->x_id_name, "%s@%s",
10298 SDATA (Vinvocation_name), SDATA (Vsystem_name));
10299
10300 /* Figure out which modifier bits mean what. */
10301 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
10302
10303 /* Get the scroll bar cursor. */
10304 #ifdef USE_GTK
10305 /* We must create a GTK cursor, it is required for GTK widgets. */
10306 dpyinfo->xg_cursor = xg_create_default_cursor (dpyinfo->display);
10307 #endif /* USE_GTK */
10308
10309 dpyinfo->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor
10310 = XCreateFontCursor (dpyinfo->display, XC_sb_v_double_arrow);
10311
10312 xrdb = x_load_resources (dpyinfo->display, xrm_option,
10313 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS);
10314 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10315 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, xrdb);
10316 #else
10317 dpyinfo->display->db = xrdb;
10318 #endif
10319 /* Put the rdb where we can find it in a way that works on
10320 all versions. */
10321 dpyinfo->xrdb = xrdb;
10322
10323 dpyinfo->screen = ScreenOfDisplay (dpyinfo->display,
10324 DefaultScreen (dpyinfo->display));
10325 select_visual (dpyinfo);
10326 dpyinfo->cmap = DefaultColormapOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10327 dpyinfo->height = HeightOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10328 dpyinfo->width = WidthOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10329 dpyinfo->root_window = RootWindowOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10330 dpyinfo->client_leader_window = 0;
10331 dpyinfo->grabbed = 0;
10332 dpyinfo->reference_count = 0;
10333 dpyinfo->icon_bitmap_id = -1;
10334 dpyinfo->font_table = NULL;
10335 dpyinfo->n_fonts = 0;
10336 dpyinfo->font_table_size = 0;
10337 dpyinfo->bitmaps = 0;
10338 dpyinfo->bitmaps_size = 0;
10339 dpyinfo->bitmaps_last = 0;
10340 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = 0;
10341 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
10342 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
10343 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
10344 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
10345 dpyinfo->mouse_face_face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
10346 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
10347 dpyinfo->mouse_face_overlay = Qnil;
10348 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x = dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y = 0;
10349 dpyinfo->mouse_face_defer = 0;
10350 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
10351 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
10352 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
10353 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
10354 dpyinfo->image_cache = make_image_cache ();
10355 dpyinfo->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
10356
10357 /* See if we can construct pixel values from RGB values. */
10358 dpyinfo->red_bits = dpyinfo->blue_bits = dpyinfo->green_bits = 0;
10359 dpyinfo->red_offset = dpyinfo->blue_offset = dpyinfo->green_offset = 0;
10360
10361 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == TrueColor)
10362 {
10363 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->red_mask,
10364 &dpyinfo->red_bits, &dpyinfo->red_offset);
10365 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->blue_mask,
10366 &dpyinfo->blue_bits, &dpyinfo->blue_offset);
10367 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->green_mask,
10368 &dpyinfo->green_bits, &dpyinfo->green_offset);
10369 }
10370
10371 /* See if a private colormap is requested. */
10372 if (dpyinfo->visual == DefaultVisualOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen))
10373 {
10374 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == PseudoColor)
10375 {
10376 Lisp_Object value;
10377 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10378 build_string ("privateColormap"),
10379 build_string ("PrivateColormap"),
10380 Qnil, Qnil);
10381 if (STRINGP (value)
10382 && (!strcmp (SDATA (value), "true")
10383 || !strcmp (SDATA (value), "on")))
10384 dpyinfo->cmap = XCopyColormapAndFree (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->cmap);
10385 }
10386 }
10387 else
10388 dpyinfo->cmap = XCreateColormap (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10389 dpyinfo->visual, AllocNone);
10390
10391 {
10392 int screen_number = XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10393 double pixels = DisplayHeight (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10394 double mm = DisplayHeightMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10395 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10396 dpyinfo->resy = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10397 pixels = DisplayWidth (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10398 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10399 mm = DisplayWidthMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10400 dpyinfo->resx = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10401 }
10402
10403 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
10404 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_PROTOCOLS", False);
10405 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus
10406 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_TAKE_FOCUS", False);
10407 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself
10408 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_SAVE_YOURSELF", False);
10409 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window
10410 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_DELETE_WINDOW", False);
10411 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_change_state
10412 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_CHANGE_STATE", False);
10413 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied
10414 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_CONFIGURE_DENIED", False);
10415 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved
10416 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_MOVED", False);
10417 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_client_leader
10418 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_CLIENT_LEADER", False);
10419 dpyinfo->Xatom_editres
10420 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "Editres", False);
10421 dpyinfo->Xatom_CLIPBOARD
10422 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "CLIPBOARD", False);
10423 dpyinfo->Xatom_TIMESTAMP
10424 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TIMESTAMP", False);
10425 dpyinfo->Xatom_TEXT
10426 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TEXT", False);
10427 dpyinfo->Xatom_COMPOUND_TEXT
10428 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "COMPOUND_TEXT", False);
10429 dpyinfo->Xatom_UTF8_STRING
10430 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "UTF8_STRING", False);
10431 dpyinfo->Xatom_DELETE
10432 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "DELETE", False);
10433 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULTIPLE
10434 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "MULTIPLE", False);
10435 dpyinfo->Xatom_INCR
10436 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "INCR", False);
10437 dpyinfo->Xatom_EMACS_TMP
10438 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_EMACS_TMP_", False);
10439 dpyinfo->Xatom_TARGETS
10440 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TARGETS", False);
10441 dpyinfo->Xatom_NULL
10442 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "NULL", False);
10443 dpyinfo->Xatom_ATOM_PAIR
10444 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "ATOM_PAIR", False);
10445 /* For properties of font. */
10446 dpyinfo->Xatom_PIXEL_SIZE
10447 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "PIXEL_SIZE", False);
10448 dpyinfo->Xatom_AVERAGE_WIDTH
10449 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "AVERAGE_WIDTH", False);
10450 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET
10451 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET", False);
10452 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE
10453 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE", False);
10454 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT
10455 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT", False);
10456
10457 /* Ghostscript support. */
10458 dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "PAGE", False);
10459 dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "DONE", False);
10460
10461 dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "SCROLLBAR",
10462 False);
10463
10464 dpyinfo->cut_buffers_initialized = 0;
10465
10466 connection = ConnectionNumber (dpyinfo->display);
10467 dpyinfo->connection = connection;
10468
10469 {
10470 char null_bits[1];
10471
10472 null_bits[0] = 0x00;
10473
10474 dpyinfo->null_pixel
10475 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10476 null_bits, 1, 1, (long) 0, (long) 0,
10477 1);
10478 }
10479
10480 {
10481 extern int gray_bitmap_width, gray_bitmap_height;
10482 extern char *gray_bitmap_bits;
10483 dpyinfo->gray
10484 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10485 gray_bitmap_bits,
10486 gray_bitmap_width, gray_bitmap_height,
10487 (unsigned long) 1, (unsigned long) 0, 1);
10488 }
10489
10490 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10491 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name);
10492 #endif
10493
10494 #ifdef subprocesses
10495 /* This is only needed for distinguishing keyboard and process input. */
10496 if (connection != 0)
10497 add_keyboard_wait_descriptor (connection);
10498 #endif
10499
10500 #ifndef F_SETOWN_BUG
10501 #ifdef F_SETOWN
10502 #ifdef F_SETOWN_SOCK_NEG
10503 /* stdin is a socket here */
10504 fcntl (connection, F_SETOWN, -getpid ());
10505 #else /* ! defined (F_SETOWN_SOCK_NEG) */
10506 fcntl (connection, F_SETOWN, getpid ());
10507 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN_SOCK_NEG) */
10508 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN) */
10509 #endif /* F_SETOWN_BUG */
10510
10511 #ifdef SIGIO
10512 if (interrupt_input)
10513 init_sigio (connection);
10514 #endif /* ! defined (SIGIO) */
10515
10516 #ifdef USE_LUCID
10517 #ifdef HAVE_X11R5 /* It seems X11R4 lacks XtCvtStringToFont, and XPointer. */
10518 /* Make sure that we have a valid font for dialog boxes
10519 so that Xt does not crash. */
10520 {
10521 Display *dpy = dpyinfo->display;
10522 XrmValue d, fr, to;
10523 Font font;
10524 int count;
10525
10526 d.addr = (XPointer)&dpy;
10527 d.size = sizeof (Display *);
10528 fr.addr = XtDefaultFont;
10529 fr.size = sizeof (XtDefaultFont);
10530 to.size = sizeof (Font *);
10531 to.addr = (XPointer)&font;
10532 count = x_catch_errors (dpy);
10533 if (!XtCallConverter (dpy, XtCvtStringToFont, &d, 1, &fr, &to, NULL))
10534 abort ();
10535 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy) || !XQueryFont (dpy, font))
10536 XrmPutLineResource (&xrdb, "Emacs.dialog.*.font: 9x15");
10537 x_uncatch_errors (dpy, count);
10538 }
10539 #endif
10540 #endif
10541
10542 /* See if we should run in synchronous mode. This is useful
10543 for debugging X code. */
10544 {
10545 Lisp_Object value;
10546 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10547 build_string ("synchronous"),
10548 build_string ("Synchronous"),
10549 Qnil, Qnil);
10550 if (STRINGP (value)
10551 && (!strcmp (SDATA (value), "true")
10552 || !strcmp (SDATA (value), "on")))
10553 XSynchronize (dpyinfo->display, True);
10554 }
10555
10556 {
10557 Lisp_Object value;
10558 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10559 build_string ("useXIM"),
10560 build_string ("UseXIM"),
10561 Qnil, Qnil);
10562 #ifdef USE_XIM
10563 if (STRINGP (value)
10564 && (!strcmp (XSTRING (value)->data, "false")
10565 || !strcmp (XSTRING (value)->data, "off")))
10566 use_xim = 0;
10567 #else
10568 if (STRINGP (value)
10569 && (!strcmp (XSTRING (value)->data, "true")
10570 || !strcmp (XSTRING (value)->data, "on")))
10571 use_xim = 1;
10572 #endif
10573 }
10574
10575 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10576 /* Only do this for the first display. */
10577 if (x_initialized == 1)
10578 x_session_initialize (dpyinfo);
10579 #endif
10580
10581 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10582
10583 return dpyinfo;
10584 }
10585 \f
10586 /* Get rid of display DPYINFO, assuming all frames are already gone,
10587 and without sending any more commands to the X server. */
10588
10589 void
10590 x_delete_display (dpyinfo)
10591 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
10592 {
10593 int i;
10594
10595 delete_keyboard_wait_descriptor (dpyinfo->connection);
10596
10597 /* Discard this display from x_display_name_list and x_display_list.
10598 We can't use Fdelq because that can quit. */
10599 if (! NILP (x_display_name_list)
10600 && EQ (XCAR (x_display_name_list), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10601 x_display_name_list = XCDR (x_display_name_list);
10602 else
10603 {
10604 Lisp_Object tail;
10605
10606 tail = x_display_name_list;
10607 while (CONSP (tail) && CONSP (XCDR (tail)))
10608 {
10609 if (EQ (XCAR (XCDR (tail)), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10610 {
10611 XSETCDR (tail, XCDR (XCDR (tail)));
10612 break;
10613 }
10614 tail = XCDR (tail);
10615 }
10616 }
10617
10618 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == dpyinfo)
10619 next_noop_dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next;
10620
10621 if (x_display_list == dpyinfo)
10622 x_display_list = dpyinfo->next;
10623 else
10624 {
10625 struct x_display_info *tail;
10626
10627 for (tail = x_display_list; tail; tail = tail->next)
10628 if (tail->next == dpyinfo)
10629 tail->next = tail->next->next;
10630 }
10631
10632 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT /* I'm told Xt does this itself. */
10633 #ifndef AIX /* On AIX, XCloseDisplay calls this. */
10634 XrmDestroyDatabase (dpyinfo->xrdb);
10635 #endif
10636 #endif
10637 #ifdef MULTI_KBOARD
10638 if (--dpyinfo->kboard->reference_count == 0)
10639 delete_kboard (dpyinfo->kboard);
10640 #endif
10641 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10642 if (dpyinfo->xim)
10643 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo);
10644 #endif
10645
10646 /* Free the font names in the font table. */
10647 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
10648 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name)
10649 {
10650 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name != dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name)
10651 xfree (dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name);
10652 xfree (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name);
10653 }
10654
10655 if (dpyinfo->font_table->font_encoder)
10656 xfree (dpyinfo->font_table->font_encoder);
10657
10658 xfree (dpyinfo->font_table);
10659 xfree (dpyinfo->x_id_name);
10660 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
10661 xfree (dpyinfo);
10662 }
10663
10664 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10665
10666 /* Atimer callback function for TIMER. Called every 0.1s to process
10667 Xt timeouts, if needed. We must avoid calling XtAppPending as
10668 much as possible because that function does an implicit XFlush
10669 that slows us down. */
10670
10671 static void
10672 x_process_timeouts (timer)
10673 struct atimer *timer;
10674 {
10675 if (toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction || popup_activated ())
10676 {
10677 BLOCK_INPUT;
10678 while (XtAppPending (Xt_app_con) & XtIMTimer)
10679 XtAppProcessEvent (Xt_app_con, XtIMTimer);
10680 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10681 }
10682 }
10683
10684 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10685
10686 \f
10687 /* Set up use of X before we make the first connection. */
10688
10689 extern frame_parm_handler x_frame_parm_handlers[];
10690
10691 static struct redisplay_interface x_redisplay_interface =
10692 {
10693 x_frame_parm_handlers,
10694 x_produce_glyphs,
10695 x_write_glyphs,
10696 x_insert_glyphs,
10697 x_clear_end_of_line,
10698 x_scroll_run,
10699 x_after_update_window_line,
10700 x_update_window_begin,
10701 x_update_window_end,
10702 x_cursor_to,
10703 x_flush,
10704 #ifdef XFlush
10705 x_flush,
10706 #else
10707 0, /* flush_display_optional */
10708 #endif
10709 x_clear_window_mouse_face,
10710 x_get_glyph_overhangs,
10711 x_fix_overlapping_area,
10712 x_draw_fringe_bitmap,
10713 0, /* define_fringe_bitmap */
10714 0, /* destroy_fringe_bitmap */
10715 x_per_char_metric,
10716 x_encode_char,
10717 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs,
10718 x_draw_glyph_string,
10719 x_define_frame_cursor,
10720 x_clear_frame_area,
10721 x_draw_window_cursor,
10722 x_draw_vertical_window_border,
10723 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert
10724 };
10725
10726 void
10727 x_initialize ()
10728 {
10729 rif = &x_redisplay_interface;
10730
10731 clear_frame_hook = x_clear_frame;
10732 ins_del_lines_hook = x_ins_del_lines;
10733 delete_glyphs_hook = x_delete_glyphs;
10734 ring_bell_hook = XTring_bell;
10735 reset_terminal_modes_hook = XTreset_terminal_modes;
10736 set_terminal_modes_hook = XTset_terminal_modes;
10737 update_begin_hook = x_update_begin;
10738 update_end_hook = x_update_end;
10739 set_terminal_window_hook = XTset_terminal_window;
10740 read_socket_hook = XTread_socket;
10741 frame_up_to_date_hook = XTframe_up_to_date;
10742 mouse_position_hook = XTmouse_position;
10743 frame_rehighlight_hook = XTframe_rehighlight;
10744 frame_raise_lower_hook = XTframe_raise_lower;
10745 set_vertical_scroll_bar_hook = XTset_vertical_scroll_bar;
10746 condemn_scroll_bars_hook = XTcondemn_scroll_bars;
10747 redeem_scroll_bar_hook = XTredeem_scroll_bar;
10748 judge_scroll_bars_hook = XTjudge_scroll_bars;
10749
10750 scroll_region_ok = 1; /* we'll scroll partial frames */
10751 char_ins_del_ok = 1;
10752 line_ins_del_ok = 1; /* we'll just blt 'em */
10753 fast_clear_end_of_line = 1; /* X does this well */
10754 memory_below_frame = 0; /* we don't remember what scrolls
10755 off the bottom */
10756 baud_rate = 19200;
10757
10758 x_noop_count = 0;
10759 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
10760 any_help_event_p = 0;
10761 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
10762
10763 #ifdef USE_GTK
10764 current_count = -1;
10765 #endif
10766
10767 /* Try to use interrupt input; if we can't, then start polling. */
10768 Fset_input_mode (Qt, Qnil, Qt, Qnil);
10769
10770 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10771 XtToolkitInitialize ();
10772
10773 Xt_app_con = XtCreateApplicationContext ();
10774
10775 /* Register a converter from strings to pixels, which uses
10776 Emacs' color allocation infrastructure. */
10777 XtAppSetTypeConverter (Xt_app_con,
10778 XtRString, XtRPixel, cvt_string_to_pixel,
10779 cvt_string_to_pixel_args,
10780 XtNumber (cvt_string_to_pixel_args),
10781 XtCacheByDisplay, cvt_pixel_dtor);
10782
10783 XtAppSetFallbackResources (Xt_app_con, Xt_default_resources);
10784
10785 /* Install an asynchronous timer that processes Xt timeout events
10786 every 0.1s. This is necessary because some widget sets use
10787 timeouts internally, for example the LessTif menu bar, or the
10788 Xaw3d scroll bar. When Xt timouts aren't processed, these
10789 widgets don't behave normally. */
10790 {
10791 EMACS_TIME interval;
10792 EMACS_SET_SECS_USECS (interval, 0, 100000);
10793 start_atimer (ATIMER_CONTINUOUS, interval, x_process_timeouts, 0);
10794 }
10795 #endif
10796
10797 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10798 #ifndef USE_GTK
10799 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = False;
10800 xaw3d_pick_top = True;
10801 #endif
10802 #endif
10803
10804 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
10805 original error handler. */
10806 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
10807 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
10808
10809 /* Disable Window Change signals; they are handled by X events. */
10810 #ifdef SIGWINCH
10811 signal (SIGWINCH, SIG_DFL);
10812 #endif /* SIGWINCH */
10813
10814 signal (SIGPIPE, x_connection_signal);
10815 }
10816
10817
10818 void
10819 syms_of_xterm ()
10820 {
10821 staticpro (&x_error_message_string);
10822 x_error_message_string = Qnil;
10823
10824 staticpro (&x_display_name_list);
10825 x_display_name_list = Qnil;
10826
10827 staticpro (&last_mouse_scroll_bar);
10828 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
10829
10830 staticpro (&Qvendor_specific_keysyms);
10831 Qvendor_specific_keysyms = intern ("vendor-specific-keysyms");
10832
10833 staticpro (&Qutf_8);
10834 Qutf_8 = intern ("utf-8");
10835 staticpro (&Qlatin_1);
10836 Qlatin_1 = intern ("latin-1");
10837
10838 staticpro (&last_mouse_press_frame);
10839 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
10840
10841 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-use-underline-position-properties",
10842 &x_use_underline_position_properties,
10843 doc: /* *Non-nil means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties.
10844 nil means ignore them. If you encounter fonts with bogus
10845 UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties, for example 7x13 on XFree prior
10846 to 4.1, set this to nil. */);
10847 x_use_underline_position_properties = 1;
10848
10849 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-mouse-click-focus-ignore-position",
10850 &x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position,
10851 doc: /* Non-nil means that a mouse click to focus a frame does not move point.
10852 This variable is only used when the window manager requires that you
10853 click on a frame to select it (give it focus). In that case, a value
10854 of nil, means that the selected window and cursor position changes to
10855 reflect the mouse click position, while a non-nil value means that the
10856 selected window or cursor position is preserved. */);
10857 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position = 0;
10858
10859 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-toolkit-scroll-bars", &Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars,
10860 doc: /* What X toolkit scroll bars Emacs uses.
10861 A value of nil means Emacs doesn't use X toolkit scroll bars.
10862 Otherwise, value is a symbol describing the X toolkit. */);
10863 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10864 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
10865 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("motif");
10866 #elif defined HAVE_XAW3D
10867 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("xaw3d");
10868 #elif USE_GTK
10869 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("gtk");
10870 #else
10871 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("xaw");
10872 #endif
10873 #else
10874 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = Qnil;
10875 #endif
10876
10877 staticpro (&last_mouse_motion_frame);
10878 last_mouse_motion_frame = Qnil;
10879
10880 Qmodifier_value = intern ("modifier-value");
10881 Qalt = intern ("alt");
10882 Fput (Qalt, Qmodifier_value, make_number (alt_modifier));
10883 Qhyper = intern ("hyper");
10884 Fput (Qhyper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (hyper_modifier));
10885 Qmeta = intern ("meta");
10886 Fput (Qmeta, Qmodifier_value, make_number (meta_modifier));
10887 Qsuper = intern ("super");
10888 Fput (Qsuper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (super_modifier));
10889
10890 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-alt-keysym", &Vx_alt_keysym,
10891 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the alt modifier.
10892 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10893 For example, `alt' means use the Alt_L and Alt_R keysyms. The default
10894 is nil, which is the same as `alt'. */);
10895 Vx_alt_keysym = Qnil;
10896
10897 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-hyper-keysym", &Vx_hyper_keysym,
10898 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the hyper modifier.
10899 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10900 For example, `hyper' means use the Hyper_L and Hyper_R keysyms. The
10901 default is nil, which is the same as `hyper'. */);
10902 Vx_hyper_keysym = Qnil;
10903
10904 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-meta-keysym", &Vx_meta_keysym,
10905 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the meta modifier.
10906 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10907 For example, `meta' means use the Meta_L and Meta_R keysyms. The
10908 default is nil, which is the same as `meta'. */);
10909 Vx_meta_keysym = Qnil;
10910
10911 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-super-keysym", &Vx_super_keysym,
10912 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the super modifier.
10913 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10914 For example, `super' means use the Super_L and Super_R keysyms. The
10915 default is nil, which is the same as `super'. */);
10916 Vx_super_keysym = Qnil;
10917
10918 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-keysym-table", &Vx_keysym_table,
10919 doc: /* Hash table of character codes indexed by X keysym codes. */);
10920 Vx_keysym_table = make_hash_table (Qeql, make_number (900),
10921 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_SIZE),
10922 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_THRESHOLD),
10923 Qnil, Qnil, Qnil);
10924 }
10925
10926 #endif /* HAVE_X_WINDOWS */
10927
10928 /* arch-tag: 6d4e4cb7-abc1-4302-9585-d84dcfb09d0f
10929 (do not change this comment) */